]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame_incremental - bfd/elf.c
Add handling for 64-bit module addresses in Cygwin core dumps
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf.c
... / ...
CommitLineData
1/* ELF executable support for BFD.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1993-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23/*
24SECTION
25 ELF backends
26
27 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
30
31 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 haven't bothered yet. */
34
35/* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
36#define _SYSCALL32
37#include "sysdep.h"
38#include <limits.h>
39#include "bfd.h"
40#include "bfdlink.h"
41#include "libbfd.h"
42#define ARCH_SIZE 0
43#include "elf-bfd.h"
44#include "libiberty.h"
45#include "safe-ctype.h"
46#include "elf-linux-core.h"
47
48#ifdef CORE_HEADER
49#include CORE_HEADER
50#endif
51
52static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
53static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
54static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int) ;
55static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
56 file_ptr offset, size_t align);
57
58/* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
59 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
60 need to move into elfcode.h. */
61
62/* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
63
64void
65_bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
66 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
67 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
68{
69 dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
70 dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
71 dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
72 dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
73 dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
74 dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
75 dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
76}
77
78/* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
79
80void
81_bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
82 const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
83 Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
84{
85 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
86 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
87 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
88 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
89 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
90 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
91 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
92}
93
94/* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
95
96void
97_bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
98 const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
99 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
100{
101 dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
102 dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
103}
104
105/* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
106
107void
108_bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
109 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
110 Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
111{
112 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
113 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
114}
115
116/* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
117
118void
119_bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
120 const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
121 Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
122{
123 dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
124 dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
125 dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
126 dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
127 dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
128}
129
130/* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
131
132void
133_bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
134 const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
135 Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
136{
137 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
138 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
139 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
140 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
141 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
142}
143
144/* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
145
146void
147_bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
148 const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
149 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
150{
151 dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
152 dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
153 dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
154 dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
155 dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
156}
157
158/* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
159
160void
161_bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
162 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
163 Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
164{
165 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
166 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
167 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
168 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
169 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
170}
171
172/* Swap in a Versym structure. */
173
174void
175_bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
176 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
177 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
178{
179 dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
180}
181
182/* Swap out a Versym structure. */
183
184void
185_bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
186 const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
187 Elf_External_Versym *dst)
188{
189 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
190}
191
192/* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
193 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
194
195unsigned long
196bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
197{
198 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
199 unsigned long h = 0;
200 unsigned long g;
201 int ch;
202
203 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
204 {
205 h = (h << 4) + ch;
206 if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
207 {
208 h ^= g >> 24;
209 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
210 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
211 h ^= g;
212 }
213 }
214 return h & 0xffffffff;
215}
216
217/* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
218 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
219
220unsigned long
221bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
222{
223 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
224 unsigned long h = 5381;
225 unsigned char ch;
226
227 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
228 h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
229 return h & 0xffffffff;
230}
231
232/* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
233 the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
234bfd_boolean
235bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
236 size_t object_size,
237 enum elf_target_id object_id)
238{
239 BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
240 abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
241 if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
242 return FALSE;
243
244 elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
245 if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
246 {
247 struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
248 if (o == NULL)
249 return FALSE;
250 elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
251 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
252 }
253 return TRUE;
254}
255
256
257bfd_boolean
258bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
259{
260 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
261 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
262 bed->target_id);
263}
264
265bfd_boolean
266bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
267{
268 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
269 if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
270 return FALSE;
271 elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
272 return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
273}
274
275char *
276bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
277{
278 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
279 bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
280 file_ptr offset;
281 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
282
283 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
284 if (i_shdrp == 0
285 || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
286 || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
287 return NULL;
288
289 shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
290 if (shstrtab == NULL)
291 {
292 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
293 offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
294 shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
295
296 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
297 in case the string table is not terminated. */
298 if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
299 || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
300 || (shstrtab = _bfd_alloc_and_read (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1,
301 shstrtabsize)) == NULL)
302 {
303 /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
304 trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
305 the string table over and over. */
306 i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
307 }
308 else
309 shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
310 i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
311 }
312 return (char *) shstrtab;
313}
314
315char *
316bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
317 unsigned int shindex,
318 unsigned int strindex)
319{
320 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
321
322 if (strindex == 0)
323 return "";
324
325 if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
326 return NULL;
327
328 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
329
330 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
331 {
332 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
333 {
334 /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
335 /* xgettext:c-format */
336 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: attempt to load strings from"
337 " a non-string section (number %d)"),
338 abfd, shindex);
339 return NULL;
340 }
341
342 if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
343 return NULL;
344 }
345 else
346 {
347 /* PR 24273: The string section's contents may have already
348 been loaded elsewhere, eg because a corrupt file has the
349 string section index in the ELF header pointing at a group
350 section. So be paranoid, and test that the last byte of
351 the section is zero. */
352 if (hdr->sh_size == 0 || hdr->contents[hdr->sh_size - 1] != 0)
353 return NULL;
354 }
355
356 if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
357 {
358 unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
359 _bfd_error_handler
360 /* xgettext:c-format */
361 (_("%pB: invalid string offset %u >= %" PRIu64 " for section `%s'"),
362 abfd, strindex, (uint64_t) hdr->sh_size,
363 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
364 ? ".shstrtab"
365 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
366 return NULL;
367 }
368
369 return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
370}
371
372/* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
373 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
374 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
375 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
376 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
377 Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
378 or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
379
380Elf_Internal_Sym *
381bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
382 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
383 size_t symcount,
384 size_t symoffset,
385 Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
386 void *extsym_buf,
387 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
388{
389 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
390 void *alloc_ext;
391 const bfd_byte *esym;
392 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
393 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
394 Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
395 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
396 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
397 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
398 size_t extsym_size;
399 size_t amt;
400 file_ptr pos;
401
402 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
403 abort ();
404
405 if (symcount == 0)
406 return intsym_buf;
407
408 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
409 shndx_hdr = NULL;
410 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd) != NULL)
411 {
412 elf_section_list * entry;
413 Elf_Internal_Shdr **sections = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
414
415 /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section. */
416 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
417 {
418 /* PR 20063. */
419 if (entry->hdr.sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
420 continue;
421
422 if (sections[entry->hdr.sh_link] == symtab_hdr)
423 {
424 shndx_hdr = & entry->hdr;
425 break;
426 };
427 }
428
429 if (shndx_hdr == NULL)
430 {
431 if (symtab_hdr == & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd))
432 /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work. */
433 shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)->hdr;
434 /* Otherwise we do nothing. The assumption is that
435 the index table will not be needed. */
436 }
437 }
438
439 /* Read the symbols. */
440 alloc_ext = NULL;
441 alloc_extshndx = NULL;
442 alloc_intsym = NULL;
443 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
444 extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
445 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount, extsym_size, &amt))
446 {
447 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
448 intsym_buf = NULL;
449 goto out;
450 }
451 pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
452 if (extsym_buf == NULL)
453 {
454 alloc_ext = bfd_malloc (amt);
455 extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
456 }
457 if (extsym_buf == NULL
458 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
459 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
460 {
461 intsym_buf = NULL;
462 goto out;
463 }
464
465 if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
466 extshndx_buf = NULL;
467 else
468 {
469 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx), &amt))
470 {
471 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
472 intsym_buf = NULL;
473 goto out;
474 }
475 pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
476 if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
477 {
478 alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *) bfd_malloc (amt);
479 extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
480 }
481 if (extshndx_buf == NULL
482 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
483 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
484 {
485 intsym_buf = NULL;
486 goto out;
487 }
488 }
489
490 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
491 {
492 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym), &amt))
493 {
494 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
495 goto out;
496 }
497 alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) bfd_malloc (amt);
498 intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
499 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
500 goto out;
501 }
502
503 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
504 isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
505 for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
506 shndx = extshndx_buf;
507 isym < isymend;
508 esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
509 if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
510 {
511 symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
512 /* xgettext:c-format */
513 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB symbol number %lu references"
514 " nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
515 ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
516 free (alloc_intsym);
517 intsym_buf = NULL;
518 goto out;
519 }
520
521 out:
522 free (alloc_ext);
523 free (alloc_extshndx);
524
525 return intsym_buf;
526}
527
528/* Look up a symbol name. */
529const char *
530bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
531 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
532 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
533 asection *sym_sec)
534{
535 const char *name;
536 unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
537 unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
538
539 if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
540 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
541 && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
542 {
543 iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
544 shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
545 }
546
547 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
548 if (name == NULL)
549 name = "(null)";
550 else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
551 name = bfd_section_name (sym_sec);
552
553 return name;
554}
555
556/* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
557 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
558 pointers. */
559
560typedef union elf_internal_group {
561 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
562 unsigned int flags;
563} Elf_Internal_Group;
564
565/* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
566 signature just a string? */
567
568static const char *
569group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
570{
571 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
572 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
573 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
574 Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
575
576 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
577 that it is a symbol table section. */
578 if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
579 return NULL;
580 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
581 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
582 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
583 return NULL;
584
585 /* Go read the symbol. */
586 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
587 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
588 &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
589 return NULL;
590
591 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
592}
593
594/* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
595
596static bfd_boolean
597setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
598{
599 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
600
601 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
602 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
603 if (num_group == 0)
604 {
605 unsigned int i, shnum;
606
607 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
608 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
609 shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
610 num_group = 0;
611
612#define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
613 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
614 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
615 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
616 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
617
618 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
619 {
620 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
621
622 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
623 num_group += 1;
624 }
625
626 if (num_group == 0)
627 {
628 num_group = (unsigned) -1;
629 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
630 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
631 }
632 else
633 {
634 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
635 so we can find them quickly. */
636 size_t amt;
637
638 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
639 amt = num_group * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *);
640 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr
641 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
642 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
643 return FALSE;
644 num_group = 0;
645
646 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
647 {
648 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
649
650 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
651 {
652 unsigned char *src;
653 Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
654
655 /* Make sure the group section has a BFD section
656 attached to it. */
657 if (!bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
658 return FALSE;
659
660 /* Add to list of sections. */
661 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
662 num_group += 1;
663
664 /* Read the raw contents. */
665 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4 && sizeof (*dest) % 4 == 0);
666 shdr->contents = NULL;
667 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (shdr->sh_size,
668 sizeof (*dest) / 4, &amt)
669 || bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
670 || !(shdr->contents
671 = _bfd_alloc_and_read (abfd, amt, shdr->sh_size)))
672 {
673 _bfd_error_handler
674 /* xgettext:c-format */
675 (_("%pB: invalid size field in group section"
676 " header: %#" PRIx64 ""),
677 abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
678 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
679 -- num_group;
680 continue;
681 }
682
683 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
684 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
685 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
686 pointers. */
687 src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
688 dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
689
690 while (1)
691 {
692 unsigned int idx;
693
694 src -= 4;
695 --dest;
696 idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
697 if (src == shdr->contents)
698 {
699 dest->shdr = NULL;
700 dest->flags = idx;
701 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
702 shdr->bfd_section->flags
703 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
704 break;
705 }
706 if (idx < shnum)
707 {
708 dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
709 /* PR binutils/23199: All sections in a
710 section group should be marked with
711 SHF_GROUP. But some tools generate
712 broken objects without SHF_GROUP. Fix
713 them up here. */
714 dest->shdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
715 }
716 if (idx >= shnum
717 || dest->shdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
718 {
719 _bfd_error_handler
720 (_("%pB: invalid entry in SHT_GROUP section [%u]"),
721 abfd, i);
722 dest->shdr = NULL;
723 }
724 }
725 }
726 }
727
728 /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
729 if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
730 {
731 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
732
733 /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
734 if (num_group == 0)
735 {
736 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
737 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
738 _bfd_error_handler
739 (_("%pB: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
740 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
741 }
742 }
743 }
744 }
745
746 if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
747 {
748 unsigned int search_offset = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset;
749 unsigned int j;
750
751 for (j = 0; j < num_group; j++)
752 {
753 /* Begin search from previous found group. */
754 unsigned i = (j + search_offset) % num_group;
755
756 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
757 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
758 bfd_size_type n_elt;
759
760 if (shdr == NULL)
761 continue;
762
763 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
764 if (idx == NULL || shdr->sh_size < 4)
765 {
766 /* See PR 21957 for a reproducer. */
767 /* xgettext:c-format */
768 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: group section '%pA' has no contents"),
769 abfd, shdr->bfd_section);
770 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i] = NULL;
771 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
772 return FALSE;
773 }
774 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
775
776 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
777 section is a member. */
778 while (--n_elt != 0)
779 if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
780 {
781 asection *s = NULL;
782
783 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
784 other members to see if any others are linked via
785 next_in_group. */
786 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
787 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
788 while (--n_elt != 0)
789 if ((++idx)->shdr != NULL
790 && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
791 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
792 break;
793 if (n_elt != 0)
794 {
795 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
796 insert current section in circular list. */
797 elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
798 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
799 elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
800 }
801 else
802 {
803 const char *gname;
804
805 gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
806 if (gname == NULL)
807 return FALSE;
808 elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
809
810 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
811 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
812 }
813
814 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
815 new member. */
816 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
817 elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
818
819 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset = i;
820 j = num_group - 1;
821 break;
822 }
823 }
824 }
825
826 if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
827 {
828 /* xgettext:c-format */
829 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: no group info for section '%pA'"),
830 abfd, newsect);
831 return FALSE;
832 }
833 return TRUE;
834}
835
836bfd_boolean
837_bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
838{
839 unsigned int i;
840 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
841 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
842 asection *s;
843
844 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
845 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
846 {
847 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
848 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
849 {
850 unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
851 /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
852 not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
853 get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
854 if (elfsec == 0)
855 {
856 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
857 bed->link_order_error_handler
858 /* xgettext:c-format */
859 (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
860 abfd, s);
861 }
862 else
863 {
864 asection *linksec = NULL;
865
866 if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
867 {
868 this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
869 linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
870 }
871
872 /* PR 1991, 2008:
873 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
874 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
875 if (linksec == NULL)
876 {
877 _bfd_error_handler
878 /* xgettext:c-format */
879 (_("%pB: sh_link [%d] in section `%pA' is incorrect"),
880 s->owner, elfsec, s);
881 result = FALSE;
882 }
883
884 elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
885 }
886 }
887 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP
888 && elf_next_in_group (s) == NULL)
889 {
890 _bfd_error_handler
891 /* xgettext:c-format */
892 (_("%pB: SHT_GROUP section [index %d] has no SHF_GROUP sections"),
893 abfd, elf_section_data (s)->this_idx);
894 result = FALSE;
895 }
896 }
897
898 /* Process section groups. */
899 if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
900 return result;
901
902 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
903 {
904 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
905 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
906 unsigned int n_elt;
907
908 /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
909 if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
910 {
911 _bfd_error_handler
912 /* xgettext:c-format */
913 (_("%pB: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
914 abfd, i);
915 result = FALSE;
916 continue;
917 }
918
919 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
920 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
921
922 while (--n_elt != 0)
923 {
924 ++ idx;
925
926 if (idx->shdr == NULL)
927 continue;
928 else if (idx->shdr->bfd_section)
929 elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
930 else if (idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA
931 && idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_REL)
932 {
933 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
934 _bfd_error_handler
935 /* xgettext:c-format */
936 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s' in group [%pA]"),
937 abfd,
938 idx->shdr->sh_type,
939 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
940 (elf_elfheader (abfd)
941 ->e_shstrndx),
942 idx->shdr->sh_name),
943 shdr->bfd_section);
944 result = FALSE;
945 }
946 }
947 }
948
949 return result;
950}
951
952bfd_boolean
953bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
954{
955 return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
956}
957
958const char *
959bfd_elf_group_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
960{
961 if (elf_sec_group (sec) != NULL)
962 return elf_group_name (sec);
963 return NULL;
964}
965
966static char *
967convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
968{
969 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
970 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
971 if (new_name == NULL)
972 return NULL;
973 new_name[0] = '.';
974 new_name[1] = 'z';
975 memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
976 return new_name;
977}
978
979static char *
980convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
981{
982 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
983 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
984 if (new_name == NULL)
985 return NULL;
986 new_name[0] = '.';
987 memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
988 return new_name;
989}
990
991/* This a copy of lto_section defined in GCC (lto-streamer.h). */
992
993struct lto_section
994{
995 int16_t major_version;
996 int16_t minor_version;
997 unsigned char slim_object;
998
999 /* Flags is a private field that is not defined publicly. */
1000 uint16_t flags;
1001};
1002
1003/* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
1004 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
1005
1006bfd_boolean
1007_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1008 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1009 const char *name,
1010 int shindex)
1011{
1012 asection *newsect;
1013 flagword flags;
1014 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1015 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
1016
1017 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
1018 return TRUE;
1019
1020 newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
1021 if (newsect == NULL)
1022 return FALSE;
1023
1024 hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
1025 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
1026 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
1027
1028 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
1029 elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
1030 elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
1031
1032 newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
1033
1034 flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
1035 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1036 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
1037 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
1038 flags |= SEC_GROUP;
1039 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
1040 {
1041 flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
1042 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1043 flags |= SEC_LOAD;
1044 }
1045 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
1046 flags |= SEC_READONLY;
1047 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
1048 flags |= SEC_CODE;
1049 else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1050 flags |= SEC_DATA;
1051 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
1052 {
1053 flags |= SEC_MERGE;
1054 newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
1055 }
1056 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
1057 flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
1058 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
1059 if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
1060 return FALSE;
1061 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
1062 flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
1063 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
1064 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1065
1066 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI])
1067 {
1068 /* FIXME: We should not recognize SHF_GNU_MBIND for ELFOSABI_NONE,
1069 but binutils as of 2019-07-23 did not set the EI_OSABI header
1070 byte. */
1071 case ELFOSABI_NONE:
1072 case ELFOSABI_GNU:
1073 case ELFOSABI_FREEBSD:
1074 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
1075 elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi |= elf_gnu_osabi_mbind;
1076 break;
1077 }
1078
1079 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
1080 {
1081 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
1082 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
1083 if (name [0] == '.')
1084 {
1085 if (strncmp (name, ".debug", 6) == 0
1086 || strncmp (name, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", 17) == 0
1087 || strncmp (name, ".zdebug", 7) == 0)
1088 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING | SEC_ELF_OCTETS;
1089 else if (strncmp (name, GNU_BUILD_ATTRS_SECTION_NAME, 21) == 0
1090 || strncmp (name, ".note.gnu", 9) == 0)
1091 {
1092 flags |= SEC_ELF_OCTETS;
1093 opb = 1;
1094 }
1095 else if (strncmp (name, ".line", 5) == 0
1096 || strncmp (name, ".stab", 5) == 0
1097 || strcmp (name, ".gdb_index") == 0)
1098 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
1099 }
1100 }
1101
1102 if (!bfd_set_section_vma (newsect, hdr->sh_addr / opb)
1103 || !bfd_set_section_size (newsect, hdr->sh_size)
1104 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (newsect, bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
1105 return FALSE;
1106
1107 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
1108 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
1109 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
1110 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
1111 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
1112 all but one of the sections. */
1113 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
1114 && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
1115 flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1116
1117 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, flags))
1118 return FALSE;
1119
1120 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1121 if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
1122 if (!bed->elf_backend_section_flags (hdr))
1123 return FALSE;
1124
1125 /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1126 separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1127 PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1128 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
1129 {
1130 bfd_byte *contents;
1131
1132 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
1133 return FALSE;
1134
1135 elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size,
1136 hdr->sh_offset, hdr->sh_addralign);
1137 free (contents);
1138 }
1139
1140 if ((newsect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1141 {
1142 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
1143 unsigned int i, nload;
1144
1145 /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1146 p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1147 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1148 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1149 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1150 for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1151 if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
1152 break;
1153 else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
1154 ++nload;
1155 if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
1156 return TRUE;
1157
1158 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1159 for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1160 {
1161 if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
1162 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
1163 || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
1164 && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
1165 {
1166 if ((newsect->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
1167 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1168 + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr) / opb;
1169 else
1170 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1171 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1172 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1173 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1174 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1175 segment will contain sections with contiguous
1176 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1177 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1178 + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset) / opb;
1179
1180 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1181 offsets whether a section with zero size should
1182 be placed at the end of one segment or the
1183 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1184 if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1185 && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1186 <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1187 break;
1188 }
1189 }
1190 }
1191
1192 /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1193 .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1194 if ((newsect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1195 && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1196 || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1197 {
1198 enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1199 int compression_header_size;
1200 bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
1201 unsigned int uncompressed_align_power;
1202 bfd_boolean compressed
1203 = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
1204 &compression_header_size,
1205 &uncompressed_size,
1206 &uncompressed_align_power);
1207 if (compressed)
1208 {
1209 /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1210 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1211 action = decompress;
1212 }
1213
1214 /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1215 section. Check if we should compress. */
1216 if (action == nothing)
1217 {
1218 if (newsect->size != 0
1219 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
1220 && compression_header_size >= 0
1221 && uncompressed_size > 0
1222 && (!compressed
1223 || ((compression_header_size > 0)
1224 != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
1225 action = compress;
1226 else
1227 return TRUE;
1228 }
1229
1230 if (action == compress)
1231 {
1232 if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1233 {
1234 _bfd_error_handler
1235 /* xgettext:c-format */
1236 (_("%pB: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1237 abfd, name);
1238 return FALSE;
1239 }
1240 }
1241 else
1242 {
1243 if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1244 {
1245 _bfd_error_handler
1246 /* xgettext:c-format */
1247 (_("%pB: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1248 abfd, name);
1249 return FALSE;
1250 }
1251 }
1252
1253 if (abfd->is_linker_input)
1254 {
1255 if (name[1] == 'z'
1256 && (action == decompress
1257 || (action == compress
1258 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
1259 {
1260 /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1261 that linker will consider this section as a debug
1262 section. */
1263 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
1264 if (new_name == NULL)
1265 return FALSE;
1266 bfd_rename_section (newsect, new_name);
1267 }
1268 }
1269 else
1270 /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1271 section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1272 newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
1273 }
1274
1275 /* GCC uses .gnu.lto_.lto.<some_hash> as a LTO bytecode information
1276 section. */
1277 const char *lto_section_name = ".gnu.lto_.lto.";
1278 if (strncmp (name, lto_section_name, strlen (lto_section_name)) == 0)
1279 {
1280 struct lto_section lsection;
1281 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, newsect, &lsection, 0,
1282 sizeof (struct lto_section)))
1283 abfd->lto_slim_object = lsection.slim_object;
1284 }
1285
1286 return TRUE;
1287}
1288
1289const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] =
1290{
1291 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1292 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1293 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1294};
1295
1296/* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1297 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1298 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1299 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1300 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1301 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1302 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1303 function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1304 relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1305
1306bfd_reloc_status_type
1307bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1308 arelent *reloc_entry,
1309 asymbol *symbol,
1310 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1311 asection *input_section,
1312 bfd *output_bfd,
1313 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1314{
1315 if (output_bfd != NULL
1316 && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1317 && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1318 || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1319 {
1320 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1321 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1322 }
1323
1324 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1325}
1326\f
1327/* Returns TRUE if section A matches section B.
1328 Names, addresses and links may be different, but everything else
1329 should be the same. */
1330
1331static bfd_boolean
1332section_match (const Elf_Internal_Shdr * a,
1333 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * b)
1334{
1335 if (a->sh_type != b->sh_type
1336 || ((a->sh_flags ^ b->sh_flags) & ~SHF_INFO_LINK) != 0
1337 || a->sh_addralign != b->sh_addralign
1338 || a->sh_entsize != b->sh_entsize)
1339 return FALSE;
1340 if (a->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
1341 || a->sh_type == SHT_STRTAB)
1342 return TRUE;
1343 return a->sh_size == b->sh_size;
1344}
1345
1346/* Find a section in OBFD that has the same characteristics
1347 as IHEADER. Return the index of this section or SHN_UNDEF if
1348 none can be found. Check's section HINT first, as this is likely
1349 to be the correct section. */
1350
1351static unsigned int
1352find_link (const bfd *obfd, const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1353 const unsigned int hint)
1354{
1355 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1356 unsigned int i;
1357
1358 BFD_ASSERT (iheader != NULL);
1359
1360 /* See PR 20922 for a reproducer of the NULL test. */
1361 if (hint < elf_numsections (obfd)
1362 && oheaders[hint] != NULL
1363 && section_match (oheaders[hint], iheader))
1364 return hint;
1365
1366 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1367 {
1368 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1369
1370 if (oheader == NULL)
1371 continue;
1372 if (section_match (oheader, iheader))
1373 /* FIXME: Do we care if there is a potential for
1374 multiple matches ? */
1375 return i;
1376 }
1377
1378 return SHN_UNDEF;
1379}
1380
1381/* PR 19938: Attempt to set the ELF section header fields of an OS or
1382 Processor specific section, based upon a matching input section.
1383 Returns TRUE upon success, FALSE otherwise. */
1384
1385static bfd_boolean
1386copy_special_section_fields (const bfd *ibfd,
1387 bfd *obfd,
1388 const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1389 Elf_Internal_Shdr *oheader,
1390 const unsigned int secnum)
1391{
1392 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1393 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1394 bfd_boolean changed = FALSE;
1395 unsigned int sh_link;
1396
1397 if (oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
1398 {
1399 /* This is a feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:
1400 When a section's type is changed to NOBITS, we preserve
1401 the sh_link and sh_info fields so that they can be
1402 matched up with the original.
1403
1404 Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1405 The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1406 relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1407 the same location as they were in the input BFD. But
1408 the whole point of this action is to preserve the
1409 original values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so
1410 that they can be matched up with the section headers in
1411 the original file. So strictly speaking we may be
1412 creating an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file
1413 that just contains debug info and only for sections
1414 without any contents. */
1415 if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
1416 oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
1417 if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
1418 oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
1419 return TRUE;
1420 }
1421
1422 /* Allow the target a chance to decide how these fields should be set. */
1423 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd,
1424 iheader, oheader))
1425 return TRUE;
1426
1427 /* We have an iheader which might match oheader, and which has non-zero
1428 sh_info and/or sh_link fields. Attempt to follow those links and find
1429 the section in the output bfd which corresponds to the linked section
1430 in the input bfd. */
1431 if (iheader->sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1432 {
1433 /* See PR 20931 for a reproducer. */
1434 if (iheader->sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
1435 {
1436 _bfd_error_handler
1437 /* xgettext:c-format */
1438 (_("%pB: invalid sh_link field (%d) in section number %d"),
1439 ibfd, iheader->sh_link, secnum);
1440 return FALSE;
1441 }
1442
1443 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_link], iheader->sh_link);
1444 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1445 {
1446 oheader->sh_link = sh_link;
1447 changed = TRUE;
1448 }
1449 else
1450 /* FIXME: Should we install iheader->sh_link
1451 if we could not find a match ? */
1452 _bfd_error_handler
1453 /* xgettext:c-format */
1454 (_("%pB: failed to find link section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1455 }
1456
1457 if (iheader->sh_info)
1458 {
1459 /* The sh_info field can hold arbitrary information, but if the
1460 SHF_LINK_INFO flag is set then it should be interpreted as a
1461 section index. */
1462 if (iheader->sh_flags & SHF_INFO_LINK)
1463 {
1464 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_info],
1465 iheader->sh_info);
1466 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1467 oheader->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
1468 }
1469 else
1470 /* No idea what it means - just copy it. */
1471 sh_link = iheader->sh_info;
1472
1473 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1474 {
1475 oheader->sh_info = sh_link;
1476 changed = TRUE;
1477 }
1478 else
1479 _bfd_error_handler
1480 /* xgettext:c-format */
1481 (_("%pB: failed to find info section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1482 }
1483
1484 return changed;
1485}
1486
1487/* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1488 another. */
1489
1490bfd_boolean
1491_bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1492{
1493 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1494 Elf_Internal_Shdr **oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1495 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1496 unsigned int i;
1497
1498 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1499 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1500 return TRUE;
1501
1502 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
1503 {
1504 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1505 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1506 }
1507
1508 elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1509
1510 /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1511 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
1512 elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
1513
1514 /* If set, copy the EI_ABIVERSION field. */
1515 if (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION])
1516 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION]
1517 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION];
1518
1519 /* Copy object attributes. */
1520 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1521
1522 if (iheaders == NULL || oheaders == NULL)
1523 return TRUE;
1524
1525 bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1526
1527 /* Possibly copy other fields in the section header. */
1528 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1529 {
1530 unsigned int j;
1531 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1532
1533 /* Ignore ordinary sections. SHT_NOBITS sections are considered however
1534 because of a special case need for generating separate debug info
1535 files. See below for more details. */
1536 if (oheader == NULL
1537 || (oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
1538 && oheader->sh_type < SHT_LOOS))
1539 continue;
1540
1541 /* Ignore empty sections, and sections whose
1542 fields have already been initialised. */
1543 if (oheader->sh_size == 0
1544 || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
1545 continue;
1546
1547 /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1548 First we try for a direct mapping between the input and output sections. */
1549 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1550 {
1551 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1552
1553 if (iheader == NULL)
1554 continue;
1555
1556 if (oheader->bfd_section != NULL
1557 && iheader->bfd_section != NULL
1558 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section != NULL
1559 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section == oheader->bfd_section)
1560 {
1561 /* We have found a connection from the input section to the
1562 output section. Attempt to copy the header fields. If
1563 this fails then do not try any further sections - there
1564 should only be a one-to-one mapping between input and output. */
1565 if (! copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1566 j = elf_numsections (ibfd);
1567 break;
1568 }
1569 }
1570
1571 if (j < elf_numsections (ibfd))
1572 continue;
1573
1574 /* That failed. So try to deduce the corresponding input section.
1575 Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1576 is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1577 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1578 {
1579 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1580
1581 if (iheader == NULL)
1582 continue;
1583
1584 /* Try matching fields in the input section's header.
1585 Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections into
1586 SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type matches any
1587 input type. */
1588 if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
1589 || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
1590 && (iheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1591 == (oheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1592 && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
1593 && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
1594 && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
1595 && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
1596 && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
1597 || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
1598 {
1599 if (copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1600 break;
1601 }
1602 }
1603
1604 if (j == elf_numsections (ibfd) && oheader->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS)
1605 {
1606 /* Final attempt. Call the backend copy function
1607 with a NULL input section. */
1608 (void) bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd,
1609 NULL, oheader);
1610 }
1611 }
1612
1613 return TRUE;
1614}
1615
1616static const char *
1617get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1618{
1619 const char *pt;
1620 switch (p_type)
1621 {
1622 case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1623 case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1624 case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1625 case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1626 case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1627 case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1628 case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1629 case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1630 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1631 case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1632 case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1633 default: pt = NULL; break;
1634 }
1635 return pt;
1636}
1637
1638/* Print out the program headers. */
1639
1640bfd_boolean
1641_bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1642{
1643 FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1644 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1645 asection *s;
1646 bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1647
1648 p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1649 if (p != NULL)
1650 {
1651 unsigned int i, c;
1652
1653 fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1654 c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1655 for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1656 {
1657 const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1658 char buf[20];
1659
1660 if (pt == NULL)
1661 {
1662 sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1663 pt = buf;
1664 }
1665 fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1666 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1667 fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1668 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1669 fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1670 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1671 fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1672 fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1673 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1674 fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1675 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1676 fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1677 (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1678 (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1679 (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1680 if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1681 fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1682 fprintf (f, "\n");
1683 }
1684 }
1685
1686 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1687 if (s != NULL)
1688 {
1689 unsigned int elfsec;
1690 unsigned long shlink;
1691 bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1692 size_t extdynsize;
1693 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1694
1695 fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1696
1697 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1698 goto error_return;
1699
1700 elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1701 if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1702 goto error_return;
1703 shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1704
1705 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1706 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1707
1708 extdyn = dynbuf;
1709 /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1710 if (s->size < extdynsize)
1711 goto error_return;
1712 extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1713 /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1714 Fix range check. */
1715 for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
1716 {
1717 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1718 const char *name = "";
1719 char ab[20];
1720 bfd_boolean stringp;
1721 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1722
1723 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1724
1725 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1726 break;
1727
1728 stringp = FALSE;
1729 switch (dyn.d_tag)
1730 {
1731 default:
1732 if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1733 name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1734
1735 if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1736 {
1737 sprintf (ab, "%#" BFD_VMA_FMT "x", dyn.d_tag);
1738 name = ab;
1739 }
1740 break;
1741
1742 case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1743 case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1744 case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1745 case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1746 case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1747 case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1748 case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1749 case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1750 case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1751 case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1752 case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1753 case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1754 case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1755 case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1756 case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1757 case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1758 case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1759 case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1760 case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1761 case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1762 case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1763 case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1764 case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1765 case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1766 case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1767 case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1768 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1769 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1770 case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1771 case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1772 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1773 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1774 case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1775 case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1776 case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1777 case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1778 case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1779 case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1780 case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1781 case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1782 case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1783 case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1784 case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1785 case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1786 case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1787 case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1788 case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1789 case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1790 case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1791 case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1792 case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1793 case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1794 case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1795 case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1796 case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1797 case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1798 case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1799 case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1800 }
1801
1802 fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1803 if (! stringp)
1804 {
1805 fprintf (f, "0x");
1806 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1807 }
1808 else
1809 {
1810 const char *string;
1811 unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1812
1813 string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1814 if (string == NULL)
1815 goto error_return;
1816 fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1817 }
1818 fprintf (f, "\n");
1819 }
1820
1821 free (dynbuf);
1822 dynbuf = NULL;
1823 }
1824
1825 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1826 || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1827 {
1828 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1829 return FALSE;
1830 }
1831
1832 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1833 {
1834 Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1835
1836 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1837 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1838 {
1839 fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1840 t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1841 t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1842 if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1843 {
1844 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1845
1846 fprintf (f, "\t");
1847 for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1848 a != NULL;
1849 a = a->vda_nextptr)
1850 fprintf (f, "%s ",
1851 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1852 fprintf (f, "\n");
1853 }
1854 }
1855 }
1856
1857 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1858 {
1859 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1860
1861 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1862 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1863 {
1864 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1865
1866 fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1867 t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1868 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1869 fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1870 a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1871 a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1872 }
1873 }
1874
1875 return TRUE;
1876
1877 error_return:
1878 free (dynbuf);
1879 return FALSE;
1880}
1881
1882/* Get version name. If BASE_P is TRUE, return "Base" for VER_FLG_BASE
1883 and return symbol version for symbol version itself. */
1884
1885const char *
1886_bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1887 bfd_boolean base_p,
1888 bfd_boolean *hidden)
1889{
1890 const char *version_string = NULL;
1891 if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
1892 && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
1893 {
1894 unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
1895
1896 *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
1897 vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
1898
1899 if (vernum == 0)
1900 version_string = "";
1901 else if (vernum == 1
1902 && (vernum > elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs
1903 || (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[0].vd_flags
1904 == VER_FLG_BASE)))
1905 version_string = base_p ? "Base" : "";
1906 else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1907 {
1908 const char *nodename
1909 = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1910 version_string = "";
1911 if (base_p
1912 || nodename == NULL
1913 || symbol->name == NULL
1914 || strcmp (symbol->name, nodename) != 0)
1915 version_string = nodename;
1916 }
1917 else
1918 {
1919 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1920
1921 version_string = _("<corrupt>");
1922 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1923 t != NULL;
1924 t = t->vn_nextref)
1925 {
1926 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1927
1928 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1929 {
1930 if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1931 {
1932 version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1933 break;
1934 }
1935 }
1936 }
1937 }
1938 }
1939 return version_string;
1940}
1941
1942/* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1943
1944void
1945bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1946 void *filep,
1947 asymbol *symbol,
1948 bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1949{
1950 FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1951 switch (how)
1952 {
1953 case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1954 fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1955 break;
1956 case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1957 fprintf (file, "elf ");
1958 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1959 fprintf (file, " %x", symbol->flags);
1960 break;
1961 case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1962 {
1963 const char *section_name;
1964 const char *name = NULL;
1965 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1966 unsigned char st_other;
1967 bfd_vma val;
1968 const char *version_string;
1969 bfd_boolean hidden;
1970
1971 section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1972
1973 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1974 if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1975 name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1976
1977 if (name == NULL)
1978 {
1979 name = symbol->name;
1980 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1981 }
1982
1983 fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1984 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1985 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1986 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1987 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1988 if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1989 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1990 else
1991 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1992 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1993
1994 /* If we have version information, print it. */
1995 version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
1996 symbol,
1997 TRUE,
1998 &hidden);
1999 if (version_string)
2000 {
2001 if (!hidden)
2002 fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
2003 else
2004 {
2005 int i;
2006
2007 fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
2008 for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
2009 putc (' ', file);
2010 }
2011 }
2012
2013 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
2014 st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
2015
2016 switch (st_other)
2017 {
2018 case 0: break;
2019 case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
2020 case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
2021 case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
2022 default:
2023 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
2024 everything hex. */
2025 fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
2026 }
2027
2028 fprintf (file, " %s", name);
2029 }
2030 break;
2031 }
2032}
2033\f
2034/* ELF .o/exec file reading */
2035
2036/* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
2037
2038bfd_boolean
2039bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
2040{
2041 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
2042 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
2043 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2044 const char *name;
2045 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
2046 static bfd_boolean * sections_being_created = NULL;
2047 static bfd * sections_being_created_abfd = NULL;
2048 static unsigned int nesting = 0;
2049
2050 if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2051 return FALSE;
2052
2053 if (++ nesting > 3)
2054 {
2055 /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
2056 sections, with each the string indices pointing to the next in the
2057 loop. Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
2058 already in the process of loading. We only trigger this test if
2059 we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
2060 can expect to recurse at least once.
2061
2062 FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
2063 rather than being held in a static pointer. */
2064
2065 if (sections_being_created_abfd != abfd)
2066 sections_being_created = NULL;
2067 if (sections_being_created == NULL)
2068 {
2069 size_t amt = elf_numsections (abfd) * sizeof (bfd_boolean);
2070
2071 /* PR 26005: Do not use bfd_zalloc here as the memory might
2072 be released before the bfd has been fully scanned. */
2073 sections_being_created = (bfd_boolean *) bfd_malloc (amt);
2074 if (sections_being_created == NULL)
2075 return FALSE;
2076 memset (sections_being_created, FALSE, amt);
2077 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2078 }
2079 if (sections_being_created [shindex])
2080 {
2081 _bfd_error_handler
2082 (_("%pB: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
2083 return FALSE;
2084 }
2085 sections_being_created [shindex] = TRUE;
2086 }
2087
2088 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
2089 ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
2090 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
2091 hdr->sh_name);
2092 if (name == NULL)
2093 goto fail;
2094
2095 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2096 switch (hdr->sh_type)
2097 {
2098 case SHT_NULL:
2099 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
2100 goto success;
2101
2102 case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
2103 case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
2104 case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
2105 case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
2106 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
2107 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
2108 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
2109 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
2110 case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
2111 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2112 goto success;
2113
2114 case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
2115 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2116 goto fail;
2117
2118 if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
2119 {
2120 /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
2121 field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
2122 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
2123 {
2124 case bfd_arch_i386:
2125 case bfd_arch_sparc:
2126 if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
2127 || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
2128 break;
2129 /* Otherwise fall through. */
2130 default:
2131 goto fail;
2132 }
2133 }
2134 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
2135 goto fail;
2136 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
2137 {
2138 Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
2139
2140 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
2141 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
2142 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
2143 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2144 {
2145 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
2146 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2147 }
2148 else
2149 {
2150 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2151
2152 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2153 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2154 {
2155 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2156 if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2157 {
2158 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2159 break;
2160 }
2161 }
2162 }
2163 }
2164 goto success;
2165
2166 case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table. */
2167 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2168 goto success;
2169
2170 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2171 goto fail;
2172
2173 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2174 {
2175 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2176 goto fail;
2177 /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2178 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2179 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2180 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2181 goto success;
2182 }
2183
2184 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
2185 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2186 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) != 0)
2187 {
2188 _bfd_error_handler
2189 /* xgettext:c-format */
2190 (_("%pB: warning: multiple symbol tables detected"
2191 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2192 abfd, shindex);
2193 goto success;
2194 }
2195 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2196 elf_symtab_hdr (abfd) = *hdr;
2197 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2198 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2199
2200 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
2201 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
2202 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
2203 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
2204 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
2205 linker. */
2206 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
2207 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
2208 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2209 shindex))
2210 goto fail;
2211
2212 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
2213 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
2214 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
2215 {
2216 elf_section_list * entry;
2217 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2218
2219 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2220 if (entry->hdr.sh_link == shindex)
2221 goto success;
2222
2223 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2224 for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2225 {
2226 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2227
2228 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2229 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2230 break;
2231 }
2232
2233 if (i == num_sec)
2234 for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
2235 {
2236 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2237
2238 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2239 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2240 break;
2241 }
2242
2243 if (i != shindex)
2244 ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
2245 /* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
2246 goto success;
2247 }
2248
2249 case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
2250 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2251 goto success;
2252
2253 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2254 goto fail;
2255
2256 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2257 {
2258 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2259 goto fail;
2260
2261 /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2262 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2263 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2264 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2265 goto success;
2266 }
2267
2268 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
2269 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2270 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2271 {
2272 _bfd_error_handler
2273 /* xgettext:c-format */
2274 (_("%pB: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected"
2275 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2276 abfd, shindex);
2277 goto success;
2278 }
2279 elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2280 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
2281 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
2282 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2283
2284 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
2285 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
2286 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2287 goto success;
2288
2289 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
2290 {
2291 elf_section_list * entry;
2292
2293 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2294 if (entry->ndx == shindex)
2295 goto success;
2296
2297 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
2298 if (entry == NULL)
2299 goto fail;
2300 entry->ndx = shindex;
2301 entry->hdr = * hdr;
2302 entry->next = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
2303 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
2304 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = & entry->hdr;
2305 goto success;
2306 }
2307
2308 case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table. */
2309 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
2310 goto success;
2311
2312 if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
2313 {
2314 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2315 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
2316 goto success;
2317 }
2318
2319 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2320 {
2321 symtab_strtab:
2322 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
2323 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
2324 goto success;
2325 }
2326
2327 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2328 {
2329 dynsymtab_strtab:
2330 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2331 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
2332 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
2333 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2334 can handle it. */
2335 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2336 shindex);
2337 goto success;
2338 }
2339
2340 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2341 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2342 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2343 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
2344 {
2345 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2346
2347 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2348 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2349 {
2350 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2351 if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2352 {
2353 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2354 if (i == shindex)
2355 goto fail;
2356 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
2357 goto fail;
2358 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
2359 goto symtab_strtab;
2360 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
2361 goto dynsymtab_strtab;
2362 }
2363 }
2364 }
2365 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2366 goto success;
2367
2368 case SHT_REL:
2369 case SHT_RELA:
2370 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2371 {
2372 asection *target_sect;
2373 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
2374 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2375 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
2376
2377 if (hdr->sh_entsize
2378 != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
2379 ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
2380 goto fail;
2381
2382 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2383 if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
2384 {
2385 _bfd_error_handler
2386 /* xgettext:c-format */
2387 (_("%pB: invalid link %u for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2388 abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex);
2389 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2390 shindex);
2391 goto success;
2392 }
2393
2394 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2395 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2396 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2397 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2398 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2399 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2400 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2401
2402 Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2403 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
2404 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
2405 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
2406 {
2407 unsigned int scan;
2408 int found;
2409
2410 found = 0;
2411 for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
2412 {
2413 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2414 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2415 {
2416 if (found != 0)
2417 {
2418 found = 0;
2419 break;
2420 }
2421 found = scan;
2422 }
2423 }
2424 if (found != 0)
2425 hdr->sh_link = found;
2426 }
2427
2428 /* Get the symbol table. */
2429 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2430 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2431 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
2432 goto fail;
2433
2434 /* If this is an alloc section in an executable or shared
2435 library, or the reloc section does not use the main symbol
2436 table we don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't
2437 adequately represent such a section, so at least for now,
2438 we don't try. We just present it as a normal section. We
2439 also can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the
2440 null section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or
2441 its sh_link points to the null section. */
2442 if (((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) != 0
2443 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2444 || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
2445 || hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
2446 || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
2447 || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
2448 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
2449 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2450 {
2451 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2452 shindex);
2453 goto success;
2454 }
2455
2456 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
2457 goto fail;
2458
2459 target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
2460 if (target_sect == NULL)
2461 goto fail;
2462
2463 esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
2464 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2465 p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
2466 else
2467 p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
2468
2469 /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7.
2470 Also see PR 24456, for a file which deliberately has two reloc
2471 sections. */
2472 if (*p_hdr != NULL)
2473 {
2474 if (!bed->init_secondary_reloc_section (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2475 {
2476 _bfd_error_handler
2477 /* xgettext:c-format */
2478 (_("%pB: warning: secondary relocation section '%s' "
2479 "for section %pA found - ignoring"),
2480 abfd, name, target_sect);
2481 }
2482 goto success;
2483 }
2484
2485 hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*hdr2));
2486 if (hdr2 == NULL)
2487 goto fail;
2488 *hdr2 = *hdr;
2489 *p_hdr = hdr2;
2490 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
2491 target_sect->reloc_count += (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr)
2492 * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
2493 target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
2494 target_sect->relocation = NULL;
2495 target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
2496 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2497 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2498 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2499 {
2500 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2501 target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
2502 }
2503 abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
2504 goto success;
2505 }
2506
2507 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2508 elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
2509 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
2510 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2511 goto success;
2512
2513 case SHT_GNU_versym:
2514 if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
2515 goto fail;
2516
2517 elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
2518 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
2519 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2520 goto success;
2521
2522 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2523 elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
2524 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
2525 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2526 goto success;
2527
2528 case SHT_SHLIB:
2529 goto success;
2530
2531 case SHT_GROUP:
2532 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
2533 goto fail;
2534
2535 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2536 goto fail;
2537
2538 goto success;
2539
2540 default:
2541 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2542 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2543 || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
2544 {
2545 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2546 goto fail;
2547 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
2548 goto success;
2549 }
2550
2551 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2552 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2553 goto success;
2554
2555 if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
2556 {
2557 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2558 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2559 for applications? */
2560 _bfd_error_handler
2561 /* xgettext:c-format */
2562 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2563 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2564 else
2565 {
2566 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2567 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2568 shindex);
2569 goto success;
2570 }
2571 }
2572 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
2573 && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
2574 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2575 _bfd_error_handler
2576 /* xgettext:c-format */
2577 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2578 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2579 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
2580 {
2581 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2582 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
2583 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2584 required to correctly process the section and the file should
2585 be rejected with an error message. */
2586 _bfd_error_handler
2587 /* xgettext:c-format */
2588 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2589 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2590 else
2591 {
2592 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2593 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2594 goto success;
2595 }
2596 }
2597 else
2598 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2599 _bfd_error_handler
2600 /* xgettext:c-format */
2601 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2602 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2603
2604 goto fail;
2605 }
2606
2607 fail:
2608 ret = FALSE;
2609 success:
2610 if (sections_being_created && sections_being_created_abfd == abfd)
2611 sections_being_created [shindex] = FALSE;
2612 if (-- nesting == 0)
2613 {
2614 free (sections_being_created);
2615 sections_being_created = NULL;
2616 sections_being_created_abfd = NULL;
2617 }
2618 return ret;
2619}
2620
2621/* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2622
2623Elf_Internal_Sym *
2624bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2625 bfd *abfd,
2626 unsigned long r_symndx)
2627{
2628 unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2629
2630 if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2631 {
2632 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2633 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2634 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2635
2636 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2637 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2638 &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2639 return NULL;
2640
2641 if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2642 {
2643 memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2644 cache->abfd = abfd;
2645 }
2646 cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2647 }
2648
2649 return &cache->sym[ent];
2650}
2651
2652/* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2653 section. */
2654
2655asection *
2656bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2657{
2658 if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2659 return NULL;
2660 return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2661}
2662
2663static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2664{
2665 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2666 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2667};
2668
2669static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2670{
2671 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2672 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ctf"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2673 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2674};
2675
2676static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2677{
2678 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2679 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2680 /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2681 unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2682 attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2683 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2684 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2685 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2686 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2687 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2688 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2689 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2690 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2691 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2692};
2693
2694static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2695{
2696 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2697 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), -2, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2698 { NULL, 0 , 0, 0, 0 }
2699};
2700
2701static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2702{
2703 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2704 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2705 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2706 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2707 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2708 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2709 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2710 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2711 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2712 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2713};
2714
2715static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2716{
2717 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2718 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2719};
2720
2721static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2722{
2723 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2724 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), -2, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2725 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2726 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2727};
2728
2729static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2730{
2731 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2732 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2733};
2734
2735static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2736{
2737 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2738 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2739 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2740};
2741
2742static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2743{
2744 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), -2, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2745 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2746 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2747};
2748
2749static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2750{
2751 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2752 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2753 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2754 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2755 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2756};
2757
2758static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2759{
2760 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2761 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2762 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2763 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2764 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2765 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2766 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2767};
2768
2769static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2770{
2771 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2772 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2773 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2774 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2775};
2776
2777static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2778{
2779 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2780 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2781 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2782 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2783 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2784};
2785
2786static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2787{
2788 special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2789 special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2790 special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2791 NULL, /* 'e' */
2792 special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2793 special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2794 special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2795 special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2796 NULL, /* 'j' */
2797 NULL, /* 'k' */
2798 special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2799 NULL, /* 'm' */
2800 special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2801 NULL, /* 'o' */
2802 special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2803 NULL, /* 'q' */
2804 special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2805 special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2806 special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2807 NULL, /* 'u' */
2808 NULL, /* 'v' */
2809 NULL, /* 'w' */
2810 NULL, /* 'x' */
2811 NULL, /* 'y' */
2812 special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2813};
2814
2815const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2816_bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2817 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2818 unsigned int rela)
2819{
2820 int i;
2821 int len;
2822
2823 len = strlen (name);
2824
2825 for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2826 {
2827 int suffix_len;
2828 int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2829
2830 if (len < prefix_len)
2831 continue;
2832 if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2833 continue;
2834
2835 suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2836 if (suffix_len <= 0)
2837 {
2838 if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2839 {
2840 if (suffix_len == 0)
2841 continue;
2842 if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2843 && (suffix_len == -2
2844 || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2845 continue;
2846 }
2847 }
2848 else
2849 {
2850 if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2851 continue;
2852 if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2853 spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2854 suffix_len) != 0)
2855 continue;
2856 }
2857 return &spec[i];
2858 }
2859
2860 return NULL;
2861}
2862
2863const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2864_bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2865{
2866 int i;
2867 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2868 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2869
2870 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2871 if (sec->name == NULL)
2872 return NULL;
2873
2874 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2875 spec = bed->special_sections;
2876 if (spec)
2877 {
2878 spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2879 bed->special_sections,
2880 sec->use_rela_p);
2881 if (spec != NULL)
2882 return spec;
2883 }
2884
2885 if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2886 return NULL;
2887
2888 i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2889 if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2890 return NULL;
2891
2892 spec = special_sections[i];
2893
2894 if (spec == NULL)
2895 return NULL;
2896
2897 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2898}
2899
2900bfd_boolean
2901_bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2902{
2903 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2904 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2905 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2906
2907 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2908 if (sdata == NULL)
2909 {
2910 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2911 sizeof (*sdata));
2912 if (sdata == NULL)
2913 return FALSE;
2914 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2915 }
2916
2917 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2918 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2919 sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2920
2921 /* Set up ELF section type and flags for newly created sections, if
2922 there is an ABI mandated section. */
2923 ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2924 if (ssect != NULL)
2925 {
2926 elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2927 elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2928 }
2929
2930 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2931}
2932
2933/* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2934
2935 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2936 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2937 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2938 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2939
2940 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2941 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2942 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2943 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2944 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2945 of combined data+bss.
2946
2947 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2948 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2949 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2950 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2951 into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2952
2953 */
2954
2955bfd_boolean
2956_bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2957 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2958 int hdr_index,
2959 const char *type_name)
2960{
2961 asection *newsect;
2962 char *name;
2963 char namebuf[64];
2964 size_t len;
2965 int split;
2966 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
2967
2968 split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2969 && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2970 && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2971
2972 if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2973 {
2974 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2975 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2976 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2977 if (!name)
2978 return FALSE;
2979 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2980 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2981 if (newsect == NULL)
2982 return FALSE;
2983 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr / opb;
2984 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr / opb;
2985 newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2986 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2987 newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2988 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2989 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2990 {
2991 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2992 newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2993 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2994 {
2995 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2996 may be data. */
2997 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2998 }
2999 }
3000 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
3001 {
3002 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
3003 }
3004 }
3005
3006 if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
3007 {
3008 bfd_vma align;
3009
3010 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
3011 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
3012 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
3013 if (!name)
3014 return FALSE;
3015 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
3016 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
3017 if (newsect == NULL)
3018 return FALSE;
3019 newsect->vma = (hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz) / opb;
3020 newsect->lma = (hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz) / opb;
3021 newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
3022 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
3023 align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
3024 if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
3025 align = hdr->p_align;
3026 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
3027 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
3028 {
3029 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
3030 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
3031 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
3032 }
3033 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
3034 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
3035 }
3036
3037 return TRUE;
3038}
3039
3040static bfd_boolean
3041_bfd_elf_core_find_build_id (bfd *templ, bfd_vma offset)
3042{
3043 /* The return value is ignored. Build-ids are considered optional. */
3044 if (templ->xvec->flavour == bfd_target_elf_flavour)
3045 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_core_find_build_id)
3046 (templ, offset);
3047 return FALSE;
3048}
3049
3050bfd_boolean
3051bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
3052{
3053 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3054
3055 switch (hdr->p_type)
3056 {
3057 case PT_NULL:
3058 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
3059
3060 case PT_LOAD:
3061 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load"))
3062 return FALSE;
3063 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core && abfd->build_id == NULL)
3064 _bfd_elf_core_find_build_id (abfd, hdr->p_offset);
3065 return TRUE;
3066
3067 case PT_DYNAMIC:
3068 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
3069
3070 case PT_INTERP:
3071 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
3072
3073 case PT_NOTE:
3074 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
3075 return FALSE;
3076 if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz,
3077 hdr->p_align))
3078 return FALSE;
3079 return TRUE;
3080
3081 case PT_SHLIB:
3082 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
3083
3084 case PT_PHDR:
3085 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
3086
3087 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
3088 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
3089 "eh_frame_hdr");
3090
3091 case PT_GNU_STACK:
3092 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
3093
3094 case PT_GNU_RELRO:
3095 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
3096
3097 default:
3098 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
3099 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3100 return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
3101 }
3102}
3103
3104/* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
3105 REL or RELA. */
3106
3107Elf_Internal_Shdr *
3108_bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
3109{
3110 if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
3111 {
3112 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
3113 return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
3114 }
3115 else
3116 return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
3117}
3118
3119static bfd_boolean
3120_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
3121 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
3122 const char *sec_name,
3123 bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
3124{
3125 char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
3126 sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
3127 if (name == NULL)
3128 return FALSE;
3129
3130 sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
3131 rel_hdr->sh_name =
3132 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
3133 FALSE);
3134 if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3135 return FALSE;
3136
3137 return TRUE;
3138}
3139
3140/* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
3141 containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
3142 USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
3143 relocations. */
3144
3145static bfd_boolean
3146_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
3147 struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
3148 const char *sec_name,
3149 bfd_boolean use_rela_p,
3150 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p)
3151{
3152 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
3153 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3154
3155 BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
3156 rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*rel_hdr));
3157 reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
3158
3159 if (delay_st_name_p)
3160 rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3161 else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
3162 use_rela_p))
3163 return FALSE;
3164 rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
3165 rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
3166 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
3167 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
3168 rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
3169 rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3170 rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3171 rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3172 rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3173
3174 return TRUE;
3175}
3176
3177/* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
3178
3179int
3180bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
3181{
3182 if ((flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_IS_COMMON)) != 0
3183 && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
3184 return SHT_NOBITS;
3185 return SHT_PROGBITS;
3186}
3187
3188struct fake_section_arg
3189{
3190 struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
3191 bfd_boolean failed;
3192};
3193
3194/* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
3195
3196static void
3197elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
3198{
3199 struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
3200 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3201 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
3202 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
3203 unsigned int sh_type;
3204 const char *name = asect->name;
3205 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p = FALSE;
3206 bfd_vma mask;
3207
3208 if (arg->failed)
3209 {
3210 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
3211 loop. */
3212 return;
3213 }
3214
3215 this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
3216
3217 if (arg->link_info)
3218 {
3219 /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
3220 if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
3221 && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
3222 && name[1] == 'd'
3223 && name[6] == '_')
3224 {
3225 /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
3226 compressed. */
3227 asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
3228 /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding section
3229 name to section name section after it is compressed in
3230 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3231 delay_st_name_p = TRUE;
3232 }
3233 }
3234 else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
3235 {
3236 /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
3237 if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
3238 {
3239 /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
3240 convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
3241 needed. */
3242 if (name[1] == 'z')
3243 {
3244 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
3245 if (new_name == NULL)
3246 {
3247 arg->failed = TRUE;
3248 return;
3249 }
3250 name = new_name;
3251 }
3252 }
3253 else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
3254 {
3255 /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
3256 section smaller. So only rename the section when
3257 compression has actually taken place. If input section
3258 name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
3259 char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
3260 if (new_name == NULL)
3261 {
3262 arg->failed = TRUE;
3263 return;
3264 }
3265 BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
3266 name = new_name;
3267 }
3268 }
3269
3270 if (delay_st_name_p)
3271 this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3272 else
3273 {
3274 this_hdr->sh_name
3275 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3276 name, FALSE);
3277 if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3278 {
3279 arg->failed = TRUE;
3280 return;
3281 }
3282 }
3283
3284 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
3285
3286 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3287 || asect->user_set_vma)
3288 this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, asect);
3289 else
3290 this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3291
3292 this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3293 this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
3294 this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3295 /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
3296 if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
3297 {
3298 _bfd_error_handler
3299 /* xgettext:c-format */
3300 (_("%pB: error: alignment power %d of section `%pA' is too big"),
3301 abfd, asect->alignment_power, asect);
3302 arg->failed = TRUE;
3303 return;
3304 }
3305 /* Set sh_addralign to the highest power of two given by alignment
3306 consistent with the section VMA. Linker scripts can force VMA. */
3307 mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power) | this_hdr->sh_addr;
3308 this_hdr->sh_addralign = mask & -mask;
3309 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
3310 copy_private_section_data. */
3311
3312 this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
3313 this_hdr->contents = NULL;
3314
3315 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
3316 asect->flags. */
3317 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
3318 sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
3319 else
3320 sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
3321
3322 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
3323 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3324 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
3325 && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
3326 && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3327 {
3328 /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
3329 allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
3330 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
3331 to a bss output section via a linker script. */
3332 _bfd_error_handler
3333 (_("warning: section `%pA' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
3334 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3335 }
3336
3337 switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
3338 {
3339 default:
3340 break;
3341
3342 case SHT_STRTAB:
3343 case SHT_NOTE:
3344 case SHT_NOBITS:
3345 case SHT_PROGBITS:
3346 break;
3347
3348 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
3349 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
3350 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
3351 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
3352 break;
3353
3354 case SHT_HASH:
3355 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
3356 break;
3357
3358 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3359 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
3360 break;
3361
3362 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3363 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
3364 break;
3365
3366 case SHT_RELA:
3367 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
3368 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3369 break;
3370
3371 case SHT_REL:
3372 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
3373 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
3374 break;
3375
3376 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3377 this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
3378 break;
3379
3380 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3381 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3382 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3383 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3384 zero. */
3385 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3386 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
3387 else
3388 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
3389 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
3390 break;
3391
3392 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3393 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3394 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3395 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3396 zero. */
3397 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3398 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
3399 else
3400 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
3401 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
3402 break;
3403
3404 case SHT_GROUP:
3405 this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
3406 break;
3407
3408 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3409 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
3410 break;
3411 }
3412
3413 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3414 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
3415 if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3416 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
3417 if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
3418 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
3419 if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
3420 {
3421 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
3422 this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
3423 }
3424 if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
3425 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
3426 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
3427 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3428 if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
3429 {
3430 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
3431 if (asect->size == 0
3432 && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
3433 {
3434 struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
3435
3436 this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3437 if (o != NULL)
3438 {
3439 this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
3440 if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
3441 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
3442 }
3443 }
3444 }
3445 if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
3446 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
3447
3448 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3449 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3450 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3451 create the other. */
3452 if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
3453 {
3454 /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3455 needed. */
3456 if (arg->link_info
3457 /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3458 && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
3459 && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
3460 || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
3461 {
3462 if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
3463 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, name,
3464 FALSE, delay_st_name_p))
3465 {
3466 arg->failed = TRUE;
3467 return;
3468 }
3469 if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
3470 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, name,
3471 TRUE, delay_st_name_p))
3472 {
3473 arg->failed = TRUE;
3474 return;
3475 }
3476 }
3477 else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
3478 (asect->use_rela_p
3479 ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
3480 name,
3481 asect->use_rela_p,
3482 delay_st_name_p))
3483 {
3484 arg->failed = TRUE;
3485 return;
3486 }
3487 }
3488
3489 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3490 sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
3491 if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
3492 && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
3493 {
3494 arg->failed = TRUE;
3495 return;
3496 }
3497
3498 if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
3499 {
3500 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3501 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3502 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3503 }
3504}
3505
3506/* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3507 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3508 when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3509 from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3510
3511void
3512bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
3513{
3514 bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
3515 asection *elt, *first;
3516 unsigned char *loc;
3517 bfd_boolean gas;
3518
3519 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3520 elfxx-ia64.c. */
3521 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP
3522 || sec->size == 0
3523 || *failedptr)
3524 return;
3525
3526 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
3527 {
3528 unsigned long symindx = 0;
3529
3530 /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3531 generic linker. */
3532 if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
3533 symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
3534
3535 if (symindx == 0)
3536 {
3537 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3538 elf_section_syms.
3539 PR 25699: A corrupt input file could contain bogus group info. */
3540 if (elf_section_syms (abfd) == NULL)
3541 {
3542 *failedptr = TRUE;
3543 return;
3544 }
3545 symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
3546 }
3547 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
3548 }
3549 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
3550 {
3551 /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3552 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3553 set until all local symbols are output. */
3554 asection *igroup;
3555 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data;
3556 unsigned long symndx;
3557 unsigned long extsymoff;
3558 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3559
3560 /* The point of this little dance to the first SHF_GROUP section
3561 then back to the SHT_GROUP section is that this gets us to
3562 the SHT_GROUP in the input object. */
3563 igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
3564 sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
3565 symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
3566 extsymoff = 0;
3567 if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
3568 {
3569 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3570
3571 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
3572 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3573 }
3574 h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
3575 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3576 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3577 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
3578
3579 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
3580 }
3581
3582 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3583 gas = TRUE;
3584 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3585 {
3586 gas = FALSE;
3587 sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
3588
3589 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3590 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
3591 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3592 {
3593 *failedptr = TRUE;
3594 return;
3595 }
3596 }
3597
3598 loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
3599
3600 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3601 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3602 start of the input section group. */
3603 first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
3604
3605 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3606 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3607 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3608 directives, not that it matters. */
3609 while (elt != NULL)
3610 {
3611 asection *s;
3612
3613 s = elt;
3614 if (!gas)
3615 s = s->output_section;
3616 if (s != NULL
3617 && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
3618 {
3619 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
3620 struct bfd_elf_section_data *input_elf_sec = elf_section_data (elt);
3621
3622 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3623 && (gas
3624 || (input_elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3625 && input_elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3626 {
3627 elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3628 loc -= 4;
3629 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rel.idx, loc);
3630 }
3631 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3632 && (gas
3633 || (input_elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3634 && input_elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3635 {
3636 elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3637 loc -= 4;
3638 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rela.idx, loc);
3639 }
3640 loc -= 4;
3641 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->this_idx, loc);
3642 }
3643 elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
3644 if (elt == first)
3645 break;
3646 }
3647
3648 loc -= 4;
3649 BFD_ASSERT (loc == sec->contents);
3650
3651 H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
3652}
3653
3654/* Given NAME, the name of a relocation section stripped of its
3655 .rel/.rela prefix, return the section in ABFD to which the
3656 relocations apply. */
3657
3658asection *
3659_bfd_elf_plt_get_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
3660{
3661 /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3662 section likely apply to .got.plt or .got section. */
3663 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
3664 && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
3665 {
3666 asection *sec;
3667
3668 name = ".got.plt";
3669 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3670 if (sec != NULL)
3671 return sec;
3672 name = ".got";
3673 }
3674
3675 return bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3676}
3677
3678/* Return the section to which RELOC_SEC applies. */
3679
3680static asection *
3681elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
3682{
3683 const char *name;
3684 unsigned int type;
3685 bfd *abfd;
3686 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3687
3688 type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
3689 if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
3690 return NULL;
3691
3692 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3693 name = reloc_sec->name;
3694 if (strncmp (name, ".rel", 4) != 0)
3695 return NULL;
3696 name += 4;
3697 if (type == SHT_RELA && *name++ != 'a')
3698 return NULL;
3699
3700 abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
3701 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3702 return bed->get_reloc_section (abfd, name);
3703}
3704
3705/* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3706 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3707 in here too, while we're at it. LINK_INFO will be 0 when arriving
3708 here for objcopy, and when using the generic ELF linker. */
3709
3710static bfd_boolean
3711assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3712{
3713 struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
3714 asection *sec;
3715 unsigned int section_number;
3716 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
3717 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
3718 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3719 size_t amt;
3720
3721 section_number = 1;
3722
3723 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3724
3725 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3726 if (link_info == NULL || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
3727 {
3728 size_t reloc_count = 0;
3729
3730 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3731 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3732 {
3733 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3734
3735 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
3736 {
3737 if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
3738 {
3739 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3740 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
3741 abfd->section_count--;
3742 }
3743 else
3744 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3745 }
3746
3747 /* Count relocations. */
3748 reloc_count += sec->reloc_count;
3749 }
3750
3751 /* Clear HAS_RELOC if there are no relocations. */
3752 if (reloc_count == 0)
3753 abfd->flags &= ~HAS_RELOC;
3754 }
3755
3756 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3757 {
3758 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3759
3760 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
3761 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3762 if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3763 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
3764 if (d->rel.hdr)
3765 {
3766 d->rel.idx = section_number++;
3767 if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3768 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
3769 }
3770 else
3771 d->rel.idx = 0;
3772
3773 if (d->rela.hdr)
3774 {
3775 d->rela.idx = section_number++;
3776 if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3777 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
3778 }
3779 else
3780 d->rela.idx = 0;
3781 }
3782
3783 need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3784 || (link_info == NULL
3785 && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3786 == HAS_RELOC)));
3787 if (need_symtab)
3788 {
3789 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
3790 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3791 if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
3792 {
3793 elf_section_list *entry;
3794
3795 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) == NULL);
3796
3797 entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
3798 entry->ndx = section_number++;
3799 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
3800 entry->hdr.sh_name
3801 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3802 ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
3803 if (entry->hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3804 return FALSE;
3805 }
3806 elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3807 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3808 }
3809
3810 elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3811 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
3812 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
3813
3814 if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
3815 {
3816 /* xgettext:c-format */
3817 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: too many sections: %u"),
3818 abfd, section_number);
3819 return FALSE;
3820 }
3821
3822 elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3823 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3824
3825 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3826 indices. */
3827 amt = section_number * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *);
3828 i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3829 if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3830 return FALSE;
3831
3832 i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3833 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3834 if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3835 {
3836 bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3837 return FALSE;
3838 }
3839
3840 elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3841
3842 i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3843 if (need_symtab)
3844 {
3845 i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3846 if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3847 {
3848 elf_section_list * entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
3849 BFD_ASSERT (entry != NULL);
3850 i_shdrp[entry->ndx] = & entry->hdr;
3851 entry->hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3852 }
3853 i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3854 t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
3855 }
3856
3857 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3858 {
3859 asection *s;
3860
3861 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3862
3863 i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3864 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3865 i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3866 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3867 i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3868
3869 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3870
3871 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3872 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3873 the relocation entries apply. */
3874 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3875 {
3876 d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3877 d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3878 d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3879 }
3880 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3881 {
3882 d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3883 d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3884 d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3885 }
3886
3887 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3888 if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3889 {
3890 s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3891 if (s)
3892 {
3893 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3894 if (discarded_section (s))
3895 {
3896 asection *kept;
3897 _bfd_error_handler
3898 /* xgettext:c-format */
3899 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3900 " discarded section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3901 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3902 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3903 size as the discarded one. */
3904 kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3905 if (kept == NULL)
3906 {
3907 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3908 return FALSE;
3909 }
3910 s = kept;
3911 }
3912 /* Handle objcopy. */
3913 else if (s->output_section == NULL)
3914 {
3915 _bfd_error_handler
3916 /* xgettext:c-format */
3917 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3918 " removed section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3919 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3920 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3921 return FALSE;
3922 }
3923 s = s->output_section;
3924 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3925 }
3926 else
3927 {
3928 /* PR 290:
3929 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3930 SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3931 sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3932 where s is NULL. */
3933 const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3934 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3935 bed->link_order_error_handler
3936 /* xgettext:c-format */
3937 (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
3938 abfd, sec);
3939 }
3940 }
3941
3942 switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3943 {
3944 case SHT_REL:
3945 case SHT_RELA:
3946 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3947 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3948 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3949 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3950 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3951 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3952 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3953 if (s != NULL)
3954 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3955
3956 s = elf_get_reloc_section (sec);
3957 if (s != NULL)
3958 {
3959 d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3960 d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3961 }
3962 break;
3963
3964 case SHT_STRTAB:
3965 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3966 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3967 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3968 field to point to this section. */
3969 if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3970 && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3971 {
3972 size_t len;
3973 char *alc;
3974
3975 len = strlen (sec->name);
3976 alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3977 if (alc == NULL)
3978 return FALSE;
3979 memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3980 alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3981 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3982 free (alc);
3983 if (s != NULL)
3984 {
3985 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3986
3987 /* This is a .stab section. */
3988 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 12;
3989 }
3990 }
3991 break;
3992
3993 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3994 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3995 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3996 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3997 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3998 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3999 version strings. */
4000 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
4001 if (s != NULL)
4002 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
4003 break;
4004
4005 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
4006 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
4007 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
4008 the version strings. */
4009 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
4010 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
4011 if (s != NULL)
4012 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
4013 break;
4014
4015 case SHT_HASH:
4016 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
4017 case SHT_GNU_versym:
4018 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
4019 this hash table or version table is for. */
4020 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
4021 if (s != NULL)
4022 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
4023 break;
4024
4025 case SHT_GROUP:
4026 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
4027 }
4028 }
4029
4030 /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
4031 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
4032 debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
4033
4034 return TRUE;
4035}
4036
4037static bfd_boolean
4038sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
4039{
4040 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
4041 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4042 if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
4043 return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
4044
4045 return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
4046 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_asymbol_section (sym))
4047 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_asymbol_section (sym)));
4048}
4049
4050/* Filter global symbols of ABFD to include in the import library. All
4051 SYMCOUNT symbols of ABFD can be examined from their pointers in
4052 SYMS. Pointers of symbols to keep should be stored contiguously at
4053 the beginning of that array.
4054
4055 Returns the number of symbols to keep. */
4056
4057unsigned int
4058_bfd_elf_filter_global_symbols (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4059 asymbol **syms, long symcount)
4060{
4061 long src_count, dst_count = 0;
4062
4063 for (src_count = 0; src_count < symcount; src_count++)
4064 {
4065 asymbol *sym = syms[src_count];
4066 char *name = (char *) bfd_asymbol_name (sym);
4067 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
4068
4069 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4070 continue;
4071
4072 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
4073 if (h == NULL)
4074 continue;
4075 if (h->type != bfd_link_hash_defined && h->type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4076 continue;
4077 if (h->linker_def || h->ldscript_def)
4078 continue;
4079
4080 syms[dst_count++] = sym;
4081 }
4082
4083 syms[dst_count] = NULL;
4084
4085 return dst_count;
4086}
4087
4088/* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
4089 output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
4090
4091static bfd_boolean
4092ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
4093{
4094 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
4095
4096 if (sym == NULL)
4097 return FALSE;
4098
4099 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
4100 return FALSE;
4101
4102 if (sym->section == NULL)
4103 return TRUE;
4104
4105 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, sym);
4106 return ((type_ptr != NULL
4107 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
4108 && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4109 || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
4110 || (sym->section->output_section != NULL
4111 && sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
4112 && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
4113 || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
4114}
4115
4116/* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
4117 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
4118
4119static bfd_boolean
4120elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
4121{
4122 unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
4123 asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
4124 asymbol **sect_syms;
4125 unsigned int num_locals = 0;
4126 unsigned int num_globals = 0;
4127 unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
4128 unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
4129 unsigned int max_index = 0;
4130 unsigned int idx;
4131 asection *asect;
4132 asymbol **new_syms;
4133 size_t amt;
4134
4135#ifdef DEBUG
4136 fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
4137 fflush (stderr);
4138#endif
4139
4140 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4141 {
4142 if (max_index < asect->index)
4143 max_index = asect->index;
4144 }
4145
4146 max_index++;
4147 amt = max_index * sizeof (asymbol *);
4148 sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4149 if (sect_syms == NULL)
4150 return FALSE;
4151 elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
4152 elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
4153
4154 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
4155 decided to output. */
4156 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4157 {
4158 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4159
4160 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
4161 && sym->value == 0
4162 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4163 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4164 {
4165 asection *sec = sym->section;
4166
4167 if (sec->owner != abfd)
4168 sec = sec->output_section;
4169
4170 sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
4171 }
4172 }
4173
4174 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
4175 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4176 {
4177 if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
4178 num_globals++;
4179 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
4180 num_locals++;
4181 }
4182
4183 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
4184 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
4185 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
4186 at least in that case. */
4187 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4188 {
4189 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4190 {
4191 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
4192 num_locals++;
4193 else
4194 num_globals++;
4195 }
4196 }
4197
4198 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
4199 amt = (num_locals + num_globals) * sizeof (asymbol *);
4200 new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4201 if (new_syms == NULL)
4202 return FALSE;
4203
4204 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4205 {
4206 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4207 unsigned int i;
4208
4209 if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4210 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4211 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
4212 i = num_locals2++;
4213 else
4214 continue;
4215 new_syms[i] = sym;
4216 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4217 }
4218 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4219 {
4220 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4221 {
4222 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
4223 unsigned int i;
4224
4225 sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
4226 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4227 i = num_locals2++;
4228 else
4229 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4230 new_syms[i] = sym;
4231 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4232 }
4233 }
4234
4235 bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
4236
4237 *pnum_locals = num_locals;
4238 return TRUE;
4239}
4240
4241/* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
4242 ELF data structure. */
4243
4244static inline file_ptr
4245align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
4246{
4247 return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
4248}
4249
4250/* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
4251 required section alignment. */
4252
4253file_ptr
4254_bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
4255 file_ptr offset,
4256 bfd_boolean align)
4257{
4258 if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
4259 offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
4260 i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
4261 if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
4262 i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
4263 if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4264 offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
4265 return offset;
4266}
4267
4268/* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
4269 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
4270 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
4271
4272bfd_boolean
4273_bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
4274 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4275{
4276 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4277 struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
4278 bfd_boolean failed;
4279 struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
4280 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
4281 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
4282
4283 if (abfd->output_has_begun)
4284 return TRUE;
4285
4286 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
4287 if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
4288 (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
4289
4290 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_init_file_header) (abfd, link_info))
4291 return FALSE;
4292
4293 fsargs.failed = FALSE;
4294 fsargs.link_info = link_info;
4295 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
4296 if (fsargs.failed)
4297 return FALSE;
4298
4299 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
4300 return FALSE;
4301
4302 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
4303 need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
4304 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
4305 || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
4306 == HAS_RELOC)));
4307 if (need_symtab)
4308 {
4309 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
4310 int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
4311
4312 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
4313 return FALSE;
4314 }
4315
4316 failed = FALSE;
4317 if (link_info == NULL)
4318 {
4319 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
4320 if (failed)
4321 return FALSE;
4322 }
4323
4324 shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
4325 /* sh_name was set in init_file_header. */
4326 shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
4327 shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
4328 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
4329 /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4330 shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
4331 shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
4332 shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
4333 /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4334 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
4335
4336 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
4337 return FALSE;
4338
4339 if (need_symtab)
4340 {
4341 file_ptr off;
4342 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4343
4344 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
4345
4346 hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4347 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4348
4349 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL)
4350 {
4351 hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
4352 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
4353 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4354 /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ? */
4355 }
4356
4357 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
4358 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4359
4360 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
4361
4362 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
4363 out. */
4364 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
4365 || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
4366 return FALSE;
4367 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
4368 }
4369
4370 abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
4371
4372 return TRUE;
4373}
4374
4375/* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
4376 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
4377
4378static bfd_size_type
4379get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4380{
4381 size_t segs;
4382 asection *s;
4383 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4384
4385 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
4386 and one for data. */
4387 segs = 2;
4388
4389 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4390 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0 && s->size != 0)
4391 {
4392 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
4393 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
4394 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
4395 targets. */
4396 segs += 2;
4397 }
4398
4399 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
4400 {
4401 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4402 ++segs;
4403 }
4404
4405 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4406 {
4407 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
4408 ++segs;
4409 }
4410
4411 if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
4412 {
4413 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
4414 ++segs;
4415 }
4416
4417 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4418 {
4419 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
4420 ++segs;
4421 }
4422
4423 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
4424 NOTE_GNU_PROPERTY_SECTION_NAME);
4425 if (s != NULL && s->size != 0)
4426 {
4427 /* We need a PT_GNU_PROPERTY segment. */
4428 ++segs;
4429 }
4430
4431 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4432 {
4433 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4434 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE)
4435 {
4436 unsigned int alignment_power;
4437 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
4438 ++segs;
4439 /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment for all adjacent
4440 loadable SHT_NOTE sections. gABI requires that within a
4441 PT_NOTE segment (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
4442 each note should have the same alignment. So we check
4443 whether the sections are correctly aligned. */
4444 alignment_power = s->alignment_power;
4445 while (s->next != NULL
4446 && s->next->alignment_power == alignment_power
4447 && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4448 && elf_section_type (s->next) == SHT_NOTE)
4449 s = s->next;
4450 }
4451 }
4452
4453 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4454 {
4455 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4456 {
4457 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
4458 ++segs;
4459 break;
4460 }
4461 }
4462
4463 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4464
4465 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4466 && (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind) != 0)
4467 {
4468 /* Add a PT_GNU_MBIND segment for each mbind section. */
4469 unsigned int page_align_power = bfd_log2 (bed->commonpagesize);
4470 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4471 if (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
4472 {
4473 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info > PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM)
4474 {
4475 _bfd_error_handler
4476 /* xgettext:c-format */
4477 (_("%pB: GNU_MBIND section `%pA' has invalid "
4478 "sh_info field: %d"),
4479 abfd, s, elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4480 continue;
4481 }
4482 /* Align mbind section to page size. */
4483 if (s->alignment_power < page_align_power)
4484 s->alignment_power = page_align_power;
4485 segs ++;
4486 }
4487 }
4488
4489 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
4490 if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
4491 {
4492 int a;
4493
4494 a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
4495 if (a == -1)
4496 abort ();
4497 segs += a;
4498 }
4499
4500 return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4501}
4502
4503/* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
4504
4505Elf_Internal_Phdr *
4506_bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
4507{
4508 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4509 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4510
4511 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4512 m != NULL;
4513 m = m->next, p++)
4514 {
4515 int i;
4516
4517 for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4518 if (m->sections[i] == section)
4519 return p;
4520 }
4521
4522 return NULL;
4523}
4524
4525/* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4526
4527static struct elf_segment_map *
4528make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
4529 asection **sections,
4530 unsigned int from,
4531 unsigned int to,
4532 bfd_boolean phdr)
4533{
4534 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4535 unsigned int i;
4536 asection **hdrpp;
4537 size_t amt;
4538
4539 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
4540 amt += (to - from) * sizeof (asection *);
4541 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4542 if (m == NULL)
4543 return NULL;
4544 m->next = NULL;
4545 m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
4546 for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
4547 m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
4548 m->count = to - from;
4549
4550 if (from == 0 && phdr)
4551 {
4552 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4553 m->includes_filehdr = 1;
4554 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4555 }
4556
4557 return m;
4558}
4559
4560/* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4561 on failure. */
4562
4563struct elf_segment_map *
4564_bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
4565{
4566 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4567
4568 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
4569 sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
4570 if (m == NULL)
4571 return NULL;
4572 m->next = NULL;
4573 m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
4574 m->count = 1;
4575 m->sections[0] = dynsec;
4576
4577 return m;
4578}
4579
4580/* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4581
4582static bfd_boolean
4583elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
4584 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4585 bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
4586{
4587 struct elf_segment_map **m;
4588 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4589
4590 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4591 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4592 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4593 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4594 removed. */
4595 m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
4596 while (*m)
4597 {
4598 unsigned int i, new_count;
4599
4600 for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
4601 {
4602 if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
4603 && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
4604 || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
4605 {
4606 (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
4607 new_count++;
4608 }
4609 }
4610 (*m)->count = new_count;
4611
4612 if (remove_empty_load
4613 && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD
4614 && (*m)->count == 0
4615 && !(*m)->includes_phdrs)
4616 *m = (*m)->next;
4617 else
4618 m = &(*m)->next;
4619 }
4620
4621 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4622 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
4623 {
4624 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
4625 return FALSE;
4626 }
4627
4628 return TRUE;
4629}
4630
4631#define IS_TBSS(s) \
4632 ((s->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) == SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4633
4634/* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4635
4636bfd_boolean
4637_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4638{
4639 unsigned int count;
4640 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4641 asection **sections = NULL;
4642 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4643 bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
4644
4645 no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
4646
4647 if (info != NULL)
4648 info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
4649
4650 if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
4651 {
4652 asection *s;
4653 unsigned int i;
4654 struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
4655 struct elf_segment_map **pm;
4656 asection *last_hdr;
4657 bfd_vma last_size;
4658 unsigned int hdr_index;
4659 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
4660 asection **hdrpp;
4661 bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment;
4662 bfd_boolean writable;
4663 bfd_boolean executable;
4664 unsigned int tls_count = 0;
4665 asection *first_tls = NULL;
4666 asection *first_mbind = NULL;
4667 asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
4668 size_t amt;
4669 bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0; /* Bytes. */
4670 bfd_size_type phdr_size; /* Octets/bytes. */
4671 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
4672
4673 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4674
4675 amt = bfd_count_sections (abfd) * sizeof (asection *);
4676 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc (amt);
4677 if (sections == NULL)
4678 goto error_return;
4679
4680 /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4681 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4682 being shifted. */
4683 addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
4684 addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
4685
4686 i = 0;
4687 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4688 {
4689 if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4690 {
4691 /* target_index is unused until bfd_elf_final_link
4692 starts output of section symbols. Use it to make
4693 qsort stable. */
4694 s->target_index = i;
4695 sections[i] = s;
4696 ++i;
4697 /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4698 if (((s->lma + s->size / opb) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
4699 wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size / opb) & addr_mask;
4700 }
4701 }
4702 BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
4703 count = i;
4704
4705 qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
4706
4707 phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
4708 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4709 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
4710 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4711 /* phdr_size is compared to LMA values which are in bytes. */
4712 phdr_size /= opb;
4713 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4714 if (maxpagesize == 0)
4715 maxpagesize = 1;
4716 phdr_in_segment = info != NULL && info->load_phdrs;
4717 if (count != 0
4718 && (((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) & (maxpagesize - 1))
4719 >= (phdr_size & (maxpagesize - 1))))
4720 /* For compatibility with old scripts that may not be using
4721 SIZEOF_HEADERS, add headers when it looks like space has
4722 been left for them. */
4723 phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4724
4725 /* Build the mapping. */
4726 mfirst = NULL;
4727 pm = &mfirst;
4728
4729 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4730 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4731 section. */
4732 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4733 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0 && s->size != 0)
4734 {
4735 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4736 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4737 if (m == NULL)
4738 goto error_return;
4739 m->next = NULL;
4740 m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
4741 m->p_flags = PF_R;
4742 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4743 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4744 phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4745 *pm = m;
4746 pm = &m->next;
4747
4748 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4749 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4750 if (m == NULL)
4751 goto error_return;
4752 m->next = NULL;
4753 m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
4754 m->count = 1;
4755 m->sections[0] = s;
4756
4757 *pm = m;
4758 pm = &m->next;
4759 }
4760
4761 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4762 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4763 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4764 last_hdr = NULL;
4765 last_size = 0;
4766 hdr_index = 0;
4767 writable = FALSE;
4768 executable = FALSE;
4769 dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4770 if (dynsec != NULL
4771 && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
4772 dynsec = NULL;
4773
4774 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4775 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4776
4777 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4778 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4779 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4780 program headers we will need. */
4781 if (phdr_in_segment && count > 0)
4782 {
4783 bfd_vma phdr_lma; /* Bytes. */
4784 bfd_boolean separate_phdr = FALSE;
4785
4786 phdr_lma = (sections[0]->lma - phdr_size) & addr_mask & -maxpagesize;
4787 if (info != NULL
4788 && info->separate_code
4789 && (sections[0]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4790 {
4791 /* If data sections should be separate from code and
4792 thus not executable, and the first section is
4793 executable then put the file and program headers in
4794 their own PT_LOAD. */
4795 separate_phdr = TRUE;
4796 if ((((phdr_lma + phdr_size - 1) & addr_mask & -maxpagesize)
4797 == (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize)))
4798 {
4799 /* The file and program headers are currently on the
4800 same page as the first section. Put them on the
4801 previous page if we can. */
4802 if (phdr_lma >= maxpagesize)
4803 phdr_lma -= maxpagesize;
4804 else
4805 separate_phdr = FALSE;
4806 }
4807 }
4808 if ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_lma
4809 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size)
4810 /* If file and program headers would be placed at the end
4811 of memory then it's probably better to omit them. */
4812 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4813 else if (phdr_lma < wrap_to)
4814 /* If a section wraps around to where we'll be placing
4815 file and program headers, then the headers will be
4816 overwritten. */
4817 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4818 else if (separate_phdr)
4819 {
4820 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, 0, 0, phdr_in_segment);
4821 if (m == NULL)
4822 goto error_return;
4823 m->p_paddr = phdr_lma * opb;
4824 m->p_vaddr_offset
4825 = (sections[0]->vma - phdr_size) & addr_mask & -maxpagesize;
4826 m->p_paddr_valid = 1;
4827 *pm = m;
4828 pm = &m->next;
4829 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4830 }
4831 }
4832
4833 for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
4834 {
4835 asection *hdr;
4836 bfd_boolean new_segment;
4837
4838 hdr = *hdrpp;
4839
4840 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4841 segment. */
4842
4843 if (last_hdr == NULL)
4844 {
4845 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4846 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4847 new_segment = FALSE;
4848 }
4849 else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
4850 {
4851 /* If this section has a different relation between the
4852 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4853 segment. */
4854 new_segment = TRUE;
4855 }
4856 else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
4857 || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
4858 {
4859 /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4860 the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4861 new_segment = TRUE;
4862 }
4863 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4864 && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4865 == (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
4866 {
4867 /* If we are demand paged then we can't map two disk
4868 pages onto the same memory page. */
4869 new_segment = FALSE;
4870 }
4871 /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4872 to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4873 around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4874 pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4875 section can be included in the current segment. */
4876 else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4877 + maxpagesize > last_hdr->lma)
4878 && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4879 + maxpagesize <= hdr->lma))
4880 {
4881 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4882 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4883 new_segment = TRUE;
4884 }
4885 else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
4886 && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
4887 {
4888 /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4889 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4890 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4891 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose. */
4892 new_segment = TRUE;
4893 }
4894 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4895 {
4896 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4897 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4898 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4899 new_segment = FALSE;
4900 }
4901 else if (info != NULL
4902 && info->separate_code
4903 && executable != ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0))
4904 {
4905 new_segment = TRUE;
4906 }
4907 else if (! writable
4908 && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4909 {
4910 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4911 segment. */
4912 new_segment = TRUE;
4913 }
4914 else
4915 {
4916 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4917 new_segment = FALSE;
4918 }
4919
4920 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4921 if (last_hdr != NULL
4922 && info != NULL
4923 && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
4924 new_segment
4925 = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
4926 last_hdr,
4927 new_segment);
4928
4929 if (! new_segment)
4930 {
4931 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4932 writable = TRUE;
4933 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4934 executable = TRUE;
4935 last_hdr = hdr;
4936 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4937 last_size = (!IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0) / opb;
4938 continue;
4939 }
4940
4941 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4942 header holding all the sections from hdr_index until hdr. */
4943
4944 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, hdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4945 if (m == NULL)
4946 goto error_return;
4947
4948 *pm = m;
4949 pm = &m->next;
4950
4951 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4952 writable = TRUE;
4953 else
4954 writable = FALSE;
4955
4956 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
4957 executable = FALSE;
4958 else
4959 executable = TRUE;
4960
4961 last_hdr = hdr;
4962 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4963 last_size = (!IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0) / opb;
4964 hdr_index = i;
4965 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4966 }
4967
4968 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4969 for .tbss. */
4970 if (last_hdr != NULL
4971 && (i - hdr_index != 1
4972 || !IS_TBSS (last_hdr)))
4973 {
4974 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, hdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4975 if (m == NULL)
4976 goto error_return;
4977
4978 *pm = m;
4979 pm = &m->next;
4980 }
4981
4982 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4983 if (dynsec != NULL)
4984 {
4985 m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4986 if (m == NULL)
4987 goto error_return;
4988 *pm = m;
4989 pm = &m->next;
4990 }
4991
4992 /* For each batch of consecutive loadable SHT_NOTE sections,
4993 add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4994 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4995 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4996 in the output file. */
4997 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4998 {
4999 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
5000 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE)
5001 {
5002 asection *s2;
5003 unsigned int alignment_power = s->alignment_power;
5004
5005 count = 1;
5006 for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
5007 {
5008 if (s2->next->alignment_power == alignment_power
5009 && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
5010 && elf_section_type (s2->next) == SHT_NOTE
5011 && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size / opb,
5012 alignment_power)
5013 == s2->next->lma)
5014 count++;
5015 else
5016 break;
5017 }
5018 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
5019 amt += count * sizeof (asection *);
5020 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5021 if (m == NULL)
5022 goto error_return;
5023 m->next = NULL;
5024 m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
5025 m->count = count;
5026 while (count > 1)
5027 {
5028 m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
5029 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
5030 s = s->next;
5031 }
5032 m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
5033 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
5034 *pm = m;
5035 pm = &m->next;
5036 }
5037 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
5038 {
5039 if (! tls_count)
5040 first_tls = s;
5041 tls_count++;
5042 }
5043 if (first_mbind == NULL
5044 && (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
5045 first_mbind = s;
5046 }
5047
5048 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
5049 if (tls_count > 0)
5050 {
5051 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
5052 amt += tls_count * sizeof (asection *);
5053 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5054 if (m == NULL)
5055 goto error_return;
5056 m->next = NULL;
5057 m->p_type = PT_TLS;
5058 m->count = tls_count;
5059 /* Mandated PF_R. */
5060 m->p_flags = PF_R;
5061 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5062 s = first_tls;
5063 for (i = 0; i < tls_count; ++i)
5064 {
5065 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
5066 {
5067 _bfd_error_handler
5068 (_("%pB: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
5069 s = first_tls;
5070 i = 0;
5071 while (i < tls_count)
5072 {
5073 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
5074 {
5075 _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %pA"), s);
5076 i++;
5077 }
5078 else
5079 _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %pA"), s);
5080 s = s->next;
5081 }
5082 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5083 goto error_return;
5084 }
5085 m->sections[i] = s;
5086 s = s->next;
5087 }
5088
5089 *pm = m;
5090 pm = &m->next;
5091 }
5092
5093 if (first_mbind
5094 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
5095 && (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind) != 0)
5096 for (s = first_mbind; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5097 if ((elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0
5098 && elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info <= PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM)
5099 {
5100 /* Mandated PF_R. */
5101 unsigned long p_flags = PF_R;
5102 if ((s->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
5103 p_flags |= PF_W;
5104 if ((s->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
5105 p_flags |= PF_X;
5106
5107 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
5108 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5109 if (m == NULL)
5110 goto error_return;
5111 m->next = NULL;
5112 m->p_type = (PT_GNU_MBIND_LO
5113 + elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
5114 m->count = 1;
5115 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5116 m->sections[0] = s;
5117 m->p_flags = p_flags;
5118
5119 *pm = m;
5120 pm = &m->next;
5121 }
5122
5123 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
5124 NOTE_GNU_PROPERTY_SECTION_NAME);
5125 if (s != NULL && s->size != 0)
5126 {
5127 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
5128 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5129 if (m == NULL)
5130 goto error_return;
5131 m->next = NULL;
5132 m->p_type = PT_GNU_PROPERTY;
5133 m->count = 1;
5134 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5135 m->sections[0] = s;
5136 m->p_flags = PF_R;
5137 *pm = m;
5138 pm = &m->next;
5139 }
5140
5141 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
5142 segment. */
5143 eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
5144 if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
5145 && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
5146 {
5147 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5148 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5149 if (m == NULL)
5150 goto error_return;
5151 m->next = NULL;
5152 m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
5153 m->count = 1;
5154 m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
5155
5156 *pm = m;
5157 pm = &m->next;
5158 }
5159
5160 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
5161 {
5162 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5163 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5164 if (m == NULL)
5165 goto error_return;
5166 m->next = NULL;
5167 m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
5168 m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
5169 m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
5170 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5171 m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
5172 if (info->stacksize > 0)
5173 {
5174 m->p_size = info->stacksize;
5175 m->p_size_valid = 1;
5176 }
5177
5178 *pm = m;
5179 pm = &m->next;
5180 }
5181
5182 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
5183 {
5184 for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
5185 {
5186 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
5187 && m->count != 0
5188 && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
5189 && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
5190 {
5191 i = m->count;
5192 while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
5193 {
5194 if (m->sections[i]->size > 0
5195 && (m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5196 == (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5197 break;
5198 }
5199
5200 if (i != (unsigned) -1)
5201 break;
5202 }
5203 }
5204
5205 /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
5206 if (m != NULL)
5207 {
5208 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5209 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5210 if (m == NULL)
5211 goto error_return;
5212 m->next = NULL;
5213 m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
5214 *pm = m;
5215 pm = &m->next;
5216 }
5217 }
5218
5219 free (sections);
5220 elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
5221 }
5222
5223 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
5224 return FALSE;
5225
5226 for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5227 ++count;
5228 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5229
5230 return TRUE;
5231
5232 error_return:
5233 free (sections);
5234 return FALSE;
5235}
5236
5237/* Sort sections by address. */
5238
5239static int
5240elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5241{
5242 const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
5243 const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
5244 bfd_size_type size1, size2;
5245
5246 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
5247 place the section into a segment. */
5248 if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
5249 return -1;
5250 else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
5251 return 1;
5252
5253 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
5254 the same, and this will do nothing. */
5255 if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
5256 return -1;
5257 else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
5258 return 1;
5259
5260 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
5261
5262#define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
5263
5264 if (TOEND (sec1))
5265 {
5266 if (!TOEND (sec2))
5267 return 1;
5268 }
5269 else if (TOEND (sec2))
5270 return -1;
5271
5272#undef TOEND
5273
5274 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
5275 before others at the same address. */
5276
5277 size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
5278 size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
5279
5280 if (size1 < size2)
5281 return -1;
5282 if (size1 > size2)
5283 return 1;
5284
5285 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5286}
5287
5288/* This qsort comparison functions sorts PT_LOAD segments first and
5289 by p_paddr, for assign_file_positions_for_load_sections. */
5290
5291static int
5292elf_sort_segments (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5293{
5294 const struct elf_segment_map *m1 = *(const struct elf_segment_map **) arg1;
5295 const struct elf_segment_map *m2 = *(const struct elf_segment_map **) arg2;
5296
5297 if (m1->p_type != m2->p_type)
5298 {
5299 if (m1->p_type == PT_NULL)
5300 return 1;
5301 if (m2->p_type == PT_NULL)
5302 return -1;
5303 return m1->p_type < m2->p_type ? -1 : 1;
5304 }
5305 if (m1->includes_filehdr != m2->includes_filehdr)
5306 return m1->includes_filehdr ? -1 : 1;
5307 if (m1->no_sort_lma != m2->no_sort_lma)
5308 return m1->no_sort_lma ? -1 : 1;
5309 if (m1->p_type == PT_LOAD && !m1->no_sort_lma)
5310 {
5311 bfd_vma lma1, lma2; /* Octets. */
5312 lma1 = 0;
5313 if (m1->p_paddr_valid)
5314 lma1 = m1->p_paddr;
5315 else if (m1->count != 0)
5316 {
5317 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (m1->sections[0]->owner,
5318 m1->sections[0]);
5319 lma1 = (m1->sections[0]->lma + m1->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5320 }
5321 lma2 = 0;
5322 if (m2->p_paddr_valid)
5323 lma2 = m2->p_paddr;
5324 else if (m2->count != 0)
5325 {
5326 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (m2->sections[0]->owner,
5327 m2->sections[0]);
5328 lma2 = (m2->sections[0]->lma + m2->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5329 }
5330 if (lma1 != lma2)
5331 return lma1 < lma2 ? -1 : 1;
5332 }
5333 if (m1->idx != m2->idx)
5334 return m1->idx < m2->idx ? -1 : 1;
5335 return 0;
5336}
5337
5338/* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
5339
5340 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
5341 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
5342 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
5343 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
5344 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
5345 which is wrong.
5346
5347 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
5348 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
5349 the page size.'' */
5350/* In other words, something like:
5351
5352 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
5353 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
5354 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
5355 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
5356 else
5357 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
5358
5359 which can be collapsed into the expression below. */
5360
5361static file_ptr
5362vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
5363{
5364 /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
5365 if (maxpagesize == 0)
5366 maxpagesize = 1;
5367 return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
5368}
5369
5370static void
5371print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
5372{
5373 unsigned int j;
5374 const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
5375 char buf[32];
5376
5377 if (pt == NULL)
5378 {
5379 if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
5380 sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
5381 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
5382 else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
5383 sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
5384 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
5385 else
5386 snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
5387 (unsigned int) m->p_type);
5388 pt = buf;
5389 }
5390 fflush (stdout);
5391 fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
5392 for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
5393 fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
5394 putc ('\n',stderr);
5395 fflush (stderr);
5396}
5397
5398static bfd_boolean
5399write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
5400{
5401 void *buf;
5402 bfd_boolean ret;
5403
5404 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
5405 return FALSE;
5406 buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
5407 if (buf == NULL)
5408 return FALSE;
5409 ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
5410 free (buf);
5411 return ret;
5412}
5413
5414/* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
5415 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
5416 the file header. */
5417
5418static bfd_boolean
5419assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5420 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5421{
5422 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5423 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5424 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_load_seg;
5425 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5426 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5427 file_ptr off; /* Octets. */
5428 bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
5429 unsigned int alloc, actual;
5430 unsigned int i, j;
5431 struct elf_segment_map **sorted_seg_map;
5432 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
5433
5434 if (link_info == NULL
5435 && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
5436 return FALSE;
5437
5438 alloc = 0;
5439 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5440 m->idx = alloc++;
5441
5442 if (alloc)
5443 {
5444 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5445 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5446 }
5447 else
5448 {
5449 /* PR binutils/12467. */
5450 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
5451 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
5452 }
5453
5454 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
5455
5456 if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
5457 {
5458 actual = alloc;
5459 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5460 }
5461 else
5462 {
5463 actual = elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5464 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
5465 == actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
5466 BFD_ASSERT (actual >= alloc);
5467 }
5468
5469 if (alloc == 0)
5470 {
5471 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5472 return TRUE;
5473 }
5474
5475 /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
5476 see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
5477 that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
5478 The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
5479 elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
5480 layout.
5481 See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
5482 where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
5483 last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
5484 phdrs = bfd_zalloc (abfd, (actual * sizeof (*phdrs)
5485 + alloc * sizeof (*sorted_seg_map)));
5486 sorted_seg_map = (struct elf_segment_map **) (phdrs + actual);
5487 elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
5488 if (phdrs == NULL)
5489 return FALSE;
5490
5491 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), j = 0; m != NULL; m = m->next, j++)
5492 {
5493 sorted_seg_map[j] = m;
5494 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
5495 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
5496 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
5497 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
5498 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
5499 if (m->count > 1
5500 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
5501 && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
5502 {
5503 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5504 m->sections[i]->target_index = i;
5505 qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
5506 elf_sort_sections);
5507 }
5508 }
5509 if (alloc > 1)
5510 qsort (sorted_seg_map, alloc, sizeof (*sorted_seg_map),
5511 elf_sort_segments);
5512
5513 maxpagesize = 1;
5514 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5515 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
5516
5517 /* Sections must map to file offsets past the ELF file header. */
5518 off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5519 /* And if one of the PT_LOAD headers doesn't include the program
5520 headers then we'll be mapping program headers in the usual
5521 position after the ELF file header. */
5522 phdr_load_seg = NULL;
5523 for (j = 0; j < alloc; j++)
5524 {
5525 m = sorted_seg_map[j];
5526 if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5527 break;
5528 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5529 {
5530 phdr_load_seg = m;
5531 break;
5532 }
5533 }
5534 if (phdr_load_seg == NULL)
5535 off += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5536
5537 for (j = 0; j < alloc; j++)
5538 {
5539 asection **secpp;
5540 bfd_vma off_adjust; /* Octets. */
5541 bfd_boolean no_contents;
5542
5543 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
5544 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
5545 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
5546 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
5547 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
5548 m = sorted_seg_map[j];
5549 p = phdrs + m->idx;
5550 p->p_type = m->p_type;
5551 p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
5552
5553 if (m->count == 0)
5554 p->p_vaddr = m->p_vaddr_offset * opb;
5555 else
5556 p->p_vaddr = (m->sections[0]->vma + m->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5557
5558 if (m->p_paddr_valid)
5559 p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
5560 else if (m->count == 0)
5561 p->p_paddr = 0;
5562 else
5563 p->p_paddr = (m->sections[0]->lma + m->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5564
5565 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5566 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5567 {
5568 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
5569 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
5570 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
5571 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
5572 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
5573 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
5574 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
5575 segment. */
5576 if (m->p_align_valid)
5577 maxpagesize = m->p_align;
5578
5579 p->p_align = maxpagesize;
5580 }
5581 else if (m->p_align_valid)
5582 p->p_align = m->p_align;
5583 else if (m->count == 0)
5584 p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
5585
5586 if (m == phdr_load_seg)
5587 {
5588 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5589 p->p_offset = off;
5590 off += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5591 }
5592
5593 no_contents = FALSE;
5594 off_adjust = 0;
5595 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5596 && m->count > 0)
5597 {
5598 bfd_size_type align; /* Bytes. */
5599 unsigned int align_power = 0;
5600
5601 if (m->p_align_valid)
5602 align = p->p_align;
5603 else
5604 {
5605 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5606 {
5607 unsigned int secalign;
5608
5609 secalign = bfd_section_alignment (*secpp);
5610 if (secalign > align_power)
5611 align_power = secalign;
5612 }
5613 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
5614 if (align < maxpagesize)
5615 align = maxpagesize;
5616 }
5617
5618 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5619 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
5620 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
5621 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
5622 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
5623 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
5624
5625 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
5626 sections. */
5627 no_contents = TRUE;
5628 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5629 if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
5630 {
5631 no_contents = FALSE;
5632 break;
5633 }
5634
5635 off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align * opb);
5636
5637 /* Broken hardware and/or kernel require that files do not
5638 map the same page with different permissions on some hppa
5639 processors. */
5640 if (j != 0
5641 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
5642 && bed->no_page_alias
5643 && (off & (maxpagesize - 1)) != 0
5644 && ((off & -maxpagesize)
5645 == ((off + off_adjust) & -maxpagesize)))
5646 off_adjust += maxpagesize;
5647 off += off_adjust;
5648 if (no_contents)
5649 {
5650 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
5651 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
5652 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
5653 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
5654 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
5655 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
5656 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
5657 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
5658 }
5659 else
5660 off_adjust = 0;
5661 }
5662 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
5663 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
5664 else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
5665 && m->count > 1
5666 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
5667 {
5668 _bfd_error_handler
5669 (_("%pB: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment"
5670 " is not the .dynamic section"),
5671 abfd);
5672 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5673 return FALSE;
5674 }
5675 /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
5676 else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
5677 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5678 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
5679
5680 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5681 {
5682 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5683 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5684 p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5685 p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5686 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5687 {
5688 if (m->count > 0)
5689 {
5690 if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off
5691 || (!m->p_paddr_valid
5692 && p->p_paddr < (bfd_vma) off))
5693 {
5694 _bfd_error_handler
5695 (_("%pB: not enough room for program headers,"
5696 " try linking with -N"),
5697 abfd);
5698 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5699 return FALSE;
5700 }
5701 p->p_vaddr -= off;
5702 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5703 p->p_paddr -= off;
5704 }
5705 }
5706 else if (sorted_seg_map[0]->includes_filehdr)
5707 {
5708 Elf_Internal_Phdr *filehdr = phdrs + sorted_seg_map[0]->idx;
5709 p->p_vaddr = filehdr->p_vaddr;
5710 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5711 p->p_paddr = filehdr->p_paddr;
5712 }
5713 }
5714
5715 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5716 {
5717 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5718 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5719 p->p_filesz += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5720 p->p_memsz += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5721 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5722 {
5723 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5724 {
5725 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = p->p_offset;
5726 if (m->count > 0)
5727 {
5728 p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5729 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5730 p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5731 }
5732 }
5733 else if (phdr_load_seg != NULL)
5734 {
5735 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr = phdrs + phdr_load_seg->idx;
5736 bfd_vma phdr_off = 0; /* Octets. */
5737 if (phdr_load_seg->includes_filehdr)
5738 phdr_off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5739 p->p_vaddr = phdr->p_vaddr + phdr_off;
5740 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5741 p->p_paddr = phdr->p_paddr + phdr_off;
5742 p->p_offset = phdr->p_offset + phdr_off;
5743 }
5744 else
5745 p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5746 }
5747 }
5748
5749 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5750 || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
5751 {
5752 if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
5753 {
5754 p->p_offset = off;
5755 if (no_contents)
5756 {
5757 /* Put meaningless p_offset for PT_LOAD segments
5758 without file contents somewhere within the first
5759 page, in an attempt to not point past EOF. */
5760 bfd_size_type align = maxpagesize;
5761 if (align < p->p_align)
5762 align = p->p_align;
5763 if (align < 1)
5764 align = 1;
5765 p->p_offset = off % align;
5766 }
5767 }
5768 else
5769 {
5770 file_ptr adjust; /* Octets. */
5771
5772 adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
5773 if (!no_contents)
5774 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5775 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5776 }
5777 }
5778
5779 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5780 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5781 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5782 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5783 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5784 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5785 {
5786 asection *sec;
5787 bfd_size_type align;
5788 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5789
5790 sec = *secpp;
5791 this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
5792 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_section_alignment (sec);
5793
5794 if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5795 || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5796 && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
5797 || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
5798 && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
5799 || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
5800 {
5801 bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr; /* Octets. */
5802 bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz; /* Octets. */
5803 bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma * opb; /* Octets. */
5804 bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end; /* Octets. */
5805
5806 if (adjust != 0
5807 && (s_start < p_end
5808 || p_end < p_start))
5809 {
5810 _bfd_error_handler
5811 /* xgettext:c-format */
5812 (_("%pB: section %pA lma %#" PRIx64 " adjusted to %#" PRIx64),
5813 abfd, sec, (uint64_t) s_start / opb,
5814 (uint64_t) p_end / opb);
5815 adjust = 0;
5816 sec->lma = p_end / opb;
5817 }
5818 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5819
5820 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5821 {
5822 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5823 {
5824 off_adjust = 0;
5825 if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
5826 {
5827 /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5828 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5829 zero it. */
5830 adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
5831 if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
5832 return FALSE;
5833 }
5834 }
5835 /* We only adjust sh_offset in SHT_NOBITS sections
5836 as would seem proper for their address when the
5837 section is first in the segment. sh_offset
5838 doesn't really have any significance for
5839 SHT_NOBITS anyway, apart from a notional position
5840 relative to other sections. Historically we
5841 didn't bother with adjusting sh_offset and some
5842 programs depend on it not being adjusted. See
5843 pr12921 and pr25662. */
5844 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS || i == 0)
5845 {
5846 off += adjust;
5847 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
5848 off_adjust += adjust;
5849 }
5850 }
5851 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5852 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5853 }
5854
5855 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5856 {
5857 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5858 everything. */
5859 if (i == 0)
5860 {
5861 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5862 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5863 p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
5864 p->p_memsz = 0;
5865 p->p_align = 1;
5866 }
5867 else
5868 {
5869 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5870 sec->filepos = 0;
5871 sec->size = 0;
5872 sec->flags = 0;
5873 continue;
5874 }
5875 }
5876 else
5877 {
5878 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5879 {
5880 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5881 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5882 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5883 }
5884 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5885 && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
5886 && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
5887 {
5888 /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5889 (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5890 final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5891 would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5892 p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5893 also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5894 p_offset value. */
5895 bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
5896 off, align);
5897 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
5898 }
5899
5900 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5901 {
5902 p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5903 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5904 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5905 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5906 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5907 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5908 }
5909 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5910 {
5911 if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5912 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5913
5914 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5915 normal segments. */
5916 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
5917 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5918 }
5919
5920 if (align > p->p_align
5921 && !m->p_align_valid
5922 && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5923 || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
5924 p->p_align = align;
5925 }
5926
5927 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5928 {
5929 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5930 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
5931 p->p_flags |= PF_X;
5932 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
5933 p->p_flags |= PF_W;
5934 }
5935 }
5936
5937 off -= off_adjust;
5938
5939 /* PR ld/20815 - Check that the program header segment, if
5940 present, will be loaded into memory. */
5941 if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR
5942 && phdr_load_seg == NULL
5943 && !(bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr != NULL
5944 && bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr (abfd, phdrs, alloc)))
5945 {
5946 /* The fix for this error is usually to edit the linker script being
5947 used and set up the program headers manually. Either that or
5948 leave room for the headers at the start of the SECTIONS. */
5949 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: error: PHDR segment not covered"
5950 " by LOAD segment"),
5951 abfd);
5952 if (link_info == NULL)
5953 return FALSE;
5954 /* Arrange for the linker to exit with an error, deleting
5955 the output file unless --noinhibit-exec is given. */
5956 link_info->callbacks->info ("%X");
5957 }
5958
5959 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5960 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5961 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5962 {
5963 bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
5964
5965 for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
5966 if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
5967 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
5968 ->this_hdr), p) != 0
5969 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
5970 ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
5971 {
5972 /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5973 check_vma = FALSE;
5974 break;
5975 }
5976
5977 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5978 {
5979 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5980 asection *sec;
5981
5982 sec = m->sections[i];
5983 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
5984 if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
5985 && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
5986 {
5987 _bfd_error_handler
5988 /* xgettext:c-format */
5989 (_("%pB: section `%pA' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
5990 abfd, sec, j);
5991 print_segment_map (m);
5992 }
5993 }
5994 }
5995 }
5996
5997 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5998
5999 if (link_info != NULL
6000 && phdr_load_seg != NULL
6001 && phdr_load_seg->includes_filehdr)
6002 {
6003 /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
6004 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
6005 A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
6006
6007 struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
6008 = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
6009 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
6010 /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
6011 if (hash != NULL
6012 && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
6013 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6014 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
6015 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
6016 {
6017 asection *s = NULL;
6018 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr = phdrs[phdr_load_seg->idx].p_vaddr / opb;
6019
6020 if (phdr_load_seg->count != 0)
6021 /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
6022 s = phdr_load_seg->sections[0];
6023 else
6024 /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
6025 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
6026 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD && m->count != 0)
6027 {
6028 s = m->sections[0];
6029 break;
6030 }
6031
6032 if (s != NULL)
6033 {
6034 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
6035 hash->root.u.def.section = s;
6036 }
6037 else
6038 {
6039 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
6040 hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6041 }
6042
6043 hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
6044 hash->def_regular = 1;
6045 hash->non_elf = 0;
6046 }
6047 }
6048
6049 return TRUE;
6050}
6051
6052/* Determine if a bfd is a debuginfo file. Unfortunately there
6053 is no defined method for detecting such files, so we have to
6054 use heuristics instead. */
6055
6056bfd_boolean
6057is_debuginfo_file (bfd *abfd)
6058{
6059 if (abfd == NULL || bfd_get_flavour (abfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6060 return FALSE;
6061
6062 Elf_Internal_Shdr **start_headers = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6063 Elf_Internal_Shdr **end_headers = start_headers + elf_numsections (abfd);
6064 Elf_Internal_Shdr **headerp;
6065
6066 for (headerp = start_headers; headerp < end_headers; headerp ++)
6067 {
6068 Elf_Internal_Shdr *header = * headerp;
6069
6070 /* Debuginfo files do not have any allocated SHT_PROGBITS sections.
6071 The only allocated sections are SHT_NOBITS or SHT_NOTES. */
6072 if ((header->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) == SHF_ALLOC
6073 && header->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
6074 && header->sh_type != SHT_NOTE)
6075 return FALSE;
6076 }
6077
6078 return TRUE;
6079}
6080
6081/* Assign file positions for the other sections, except for compressed debugging
6082 and other sections assigned in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load(). */
6083
6084static bfd_boolean
6085assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
6086 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6087{
6088 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6089 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
6090 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
6091 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
6092 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
6093 struct elf_segment_map *m;
6094 file_ptr off;
6095 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
6096
6097 i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6098 end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6099 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6100 for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
6101 {
6102 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6103
6104 hdr = *hdrpp;
6105 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6106 && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
6107 || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
6108 && hdr->contents == NULL)))
6109 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
6110 else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
6111 {
6112 if (hdr->sh_size != 0
6113 /* PR 24717 - debuginfo files are known to be not strictly
6114 compliant with the ELF standard. In particular they often
6115 have .note.gnu.property sections that are outside of any
6116 loadable segment. This is not a problem for such files,
6117 so do not warn about them. */
6118 && ! is_debuginfo_file (abfd))
6119 _bfd_error_handler
6120 /* xgettext:c-format */
6121 (_("%pB: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
6122 abfd,
6123 (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
6124 ? "*unknown*"
6125 : hdr->bfd_section->name));
6126 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
6127 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
6128 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
6129 bed->maxpagesize);
6130 else
6131 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
6132 hdr->sh_addralign);
6133 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
6134 FALSE);
6135 }
6136 else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
6137 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
6138 /* We don't know the offset of these sections yet: their size has
6139 not been decided. */
6140 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6141 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
6142 || (bfd_section_is_ctf (hdr->bfd_section)
6143 && abfd->is_linker_output)))
6144 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
6145 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
6146 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
6147 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
6148 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
6149 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
6150 else
6151 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
6152 }
6153 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6154
6155 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
6156 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
6157 phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
6158 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
6159 {
6160 if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6161 {
6162 bfd_vma start, end; /* Bytes. */
6163 bfd_boolean ok;
6164
6165 if (link_info != NULL)
6166 {
6167 /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
6168 in link_info. Note that there may be padding between
6169 relro_start and the first RELRO section. */
6170 start = link_info->relro_start;
6171 end = link_info->relro_end;
6172 }
6173 else if (m->count != 0)
6174 {
6175 if (!m->p_size_valid)
6176 abort ();
6177 start = m->sections[0]->vma;
6178 end = start + m->p_size / opb;
6179 }
6180 else
6181 {
6182 start = 0;
6183 end = 0;
6184 }
6185
6186 ok = FALSE;
6187 if (start < end)
6188 {
6189 struct elf_segment_map *lm;
6190 const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
6191 unsigned int i;
6192
6193 /* Find a LOAD segment containing a section in the RELRO
6194 segment. */
6195 for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
6196 lm != NULL;
6197 lm = lm->next, lp++)
6198 {
6199 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
6200 && lm->count != 0
6201 && (lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->vma
6202 + (!IS_TBSS (lm->sections[lm->count - 1])
6203 ? lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->size / opb
6204 : 0)) > start
6205 && lm->sections[0]->vma < end)
6206 break;
6207 }
6208
6209 if (lm != NULL)
6210 {
6211 /* Find the section starting the RELRO segment. */
6212 for (i = 0; i < lm->count; i++)
6213 {
6214 asection *s = lm->sections[i];
6215 if (s->vma >= start
6216 && s->vma < end
6217 && s->size != 0)
6218 break;
6219 }
6220
6221 if (i < lm->count)
6222 {
6223 p->p_vaddr = lm->sections[i]->vma * opb;
6224 p->p_paddr = lm->sections[i]->lma * opb;
6225 p->p_offset = lm->sections[i]->filepos;
6226 p->p_memsz = end * opb - p->p_vaddr;
6227 p->p_filesz = p->p_memsz;
6228
6229 /* The RELRO segment typically ends a few bytes
6230 into .got.plt but other layouts are possible.
6231 In cases where the end does not match any
6232 loaded section (for instance is in file
6233 padding), trim p_filesz back to correspond to
6234 the end of loaded section contents. */
6235 if (p->p_filesz > lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr)
6236 p->p_filesz = lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr;
6237
6238 /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are
6239 valid. The gold linker generates RW/4 for
6240 the PT_GNU_RELRO section. It is better for
6241 objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
6242 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate
6243 debug files. */
6244 if (!m->p_align_valid)
6245 p->p_align = 1;
6246 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
6247 p->p_flags = PF_R;
6248 ok = TRUE;
6249 }
6250 }
6251 }
6252 if (link_info != NULL)
6253 BFD_ASSERT (ok);
6254 if (!ok)
6255 memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
6256 }
6257 else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
6258 {
6259 if (m->p_size_valid)
6260 p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
6261 }
6262 else if (m->count != 0)
6263 {
6264 unsigned int i;
6265
6266 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
6267 && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
6268 || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
6269 {
6270 /* A user specified segment layout may include a PHDR
6271 segment that overlaps with a LOAD segment... */
6272 if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR)
6273 {
6274 m->count = 0;
6275 continue;
6276 }
6277
6278 if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
6279 {
6280 /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
6281 _bfd_error_handler
6282 (_("%pB: error: non-load segment %d includes file header "
6283 "and/or program header"),
6284 abfd, (int) (p - phdrs));
6285 return FALSE;
6286 }
6287
6288 p->p_filesz = 0;
6289 p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
6290 for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
6291 {
6292 asection *sect = m->sections[i];
6293 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
6294 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
6295 {
6296 p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
6297 + hdr->sh_size);
6298 break;
6299 }
6300 }
6301 }
6302 }
6303 }
6304
6305 return TRUE;
6306}
6307
6308static elf_section_list *
6309find_section_in_list (unsigned int i, elf_section_list * list)
6310{
6311 for (;list != NULL; list = list->next)
6312 if (list->ndx == i)
6313 break;
6314 return list;
6315}
6316
6317/* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
6318 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
6319 VMAs must be known before this is called.
6320
6321 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
6322 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and those that
6323 bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are stored in a normal
6324 bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't consider the former sort
6325 here, unless they form part of the loadable image. Reloc sections not
6326 assigned here (and compressed debugging sections and CTF sections which
6327 nothing else in the file can rely upon) will be handled later by
6328 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
6329
6330 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
6331
6332static bfd_boolean
6333assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
6334 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6335{
6336 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
6337 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6338 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6339 unsigned int alloc;
6340
6341 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
6342 && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
6343 {
6344 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6345 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6346 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
6347 unsigned int i;
6348 file_ptr off;
6349
6350 /* Start after the ELF header. */
6351 off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
6352
6353 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
6354 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
6355 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
6356 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
6357 {
6358 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6359
6360 hdr = *hdrpp;
6361 if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
6362 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
6363 /* Do not assign offsets for these sections yet: we don't know
6364 their sizes. */
6365 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6366 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
6367 || (bfd_section_is_ctf (hdr->bfd_section)
6368 && abfd->is_linker_output)))
6369 || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
6370 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
6371 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
6372 || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
6373 || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
6374 {
6375 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
6376 }
6377 else
6378 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
6379 }
6380
6381 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6382 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = 0;
6383 }
6384 else
6385 {
6386 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
6387 assignment of sections to segments. */
6388 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6389 return FALSE;
6390
6391 /* And for non-load sections. */
6392 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6393 return FALSE;
6394 }
6395
6396 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_headers) (abfd, link_info))
6397 return FALSE;
6398
6399 /* Write out the program headers. */
6400 alloc = i_ehdrp->e_phnum;
6401 if (alloc != 0)
6402 {
6403 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_ehdrp->e_phoff, SEEK_SET) != 0
6404 || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
6405 return FALSE;
6406 }
6407
6408 return TRUE;
6409}
6410
6411bfd_boolean
6412_bfd_elf_init_file_header (bfd *abfd,
6413 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6414{
6415 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
6416 struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
6417 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6418
6419 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6420
6421 shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
6422 if (shstrtab == NULL)
6423 return FALSE;
6424
6425 elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
6426
6427 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
6428 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
6429 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
6430 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
6431
6432 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
6433 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
6434 bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
6435 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
6436
6437 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6438 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
6439 else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
6440 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6441 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
6442 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
6443 else
6444 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
6445
6446 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
6447 {
6448 case bfd_arch_unknown:
6449 i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
6450 break;
6451
6452 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
6453 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
6454 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
6455 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
6456 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
6457 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
6458 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
6459 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
6460 default:
6461 i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
6462 }
6463
6464 i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
6465 i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
6466
6467 /* No program header, for now. */
6468 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6469 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6470 i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
6471
6472 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
6473 i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
6474 i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
6475
6476 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
6477 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
6478 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
6479 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
6480 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
6481 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
6482 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6483 || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6484 || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
6485 return FALSE;
6486
6487 return TRUE;
6488}
6489
6490/* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=.
6491
6492 FIXME: We used to have code here to sort the PT_LOAD segments into
6493 ascending order, as per the ELF spec. But this breaks some programs,
6494 including the Linux kernel. But really either the spec should be
6495 changed or the programs updated. */
6496
6497bfd_boolean
6498_bfd_elf_modify_headers (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6499{
6500 if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
6501 {
6502 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (obfd);
6503 unsigned int num_segments = i_ehdrp->e_phnum;
6504 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (obfd);
6505 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = tdata->phdr;
6506 Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
6507
6508 /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
6509 bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
6510 for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
6511 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
6512 p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6513
6514 /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
6515 segments is non-zero. */
6516 if (p_vaddr)
6517 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6518 }
6519 return TRUE;
6520}
6521
6522/* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
6523 of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
6524
6525static bfd_boolean
6526_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
6527{
6528 file_ptr off;
6529 Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
6530 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
6531 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
6532 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6533
6534 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6535
6536 shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6537 end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6538 for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
6539 {
6540 shdrp = *shdrpp;
6541 if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
6542 {
6543 asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
6544 bfd_boolean is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
6545 || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
6546 bfd_boolean is_ctf = sec && bfd_section_is_ctf (sec);
6547 if (is_rel
6548 || is_ctf
6549 || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
6550 {
6551 if (!is_rel && !is_ctf)
6552 {
6553 const char *name = sec->name;
6554 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
6555
6556 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6557 if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
6558 shdrp->contents))
6559 return FALSE;
6560
6561 if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
6562 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
6563 {
6564 /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
6565 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
6566 char *new_name
6567 = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
6568 if (new_name == NULL)
6569 return FALSE;
6570 name = new_name;
6571 }
6572 /* Add section name to section name section. */
6573 if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
6574 abort ();
6575 shdrp->sh_name
6576 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6577 name, FALSE);
6578 d = elf_section_data (sec);
6579
6580 /* Add reloc section name to section name section. */
6581 if (d->rel.hdr
6582 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6583 d->rel.hdr,
6584 name, FALSE))
6585 return FALSE;
6586 if (d->rela.hdr
6587 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6588 d->rela.hdr,
6589 name, TRUE))
6590 return FALSE;
6591
6592 /* Update section size and contents. */
6593 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6594 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6595 shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
6596 }
6597 else if (is_ctf)
6598 {
6599 /* Update section size and contents. */
6600 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6601 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6602 }
6603
6604 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
6605 off,
6606 TRUE);
6607 }
6608 }
6609 }
6610
6611 /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
6612 compressed. */
6613 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6614 shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
6615 shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6616 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
6617
6618 /* Place the section headers. */
6619 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6620 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6621 off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
6622 i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
6623 off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
6624 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6625
6626 return TRUE;
6627}
6628
6629bfd_boolean
6630_bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
6631{
6632 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6633 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
6634 bfd_boolean failed;
6635 unsigned int count, num_sec;
6636 struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
6637
6638 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
6639 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
6640 return FALSE;
6641 /* Do not rewrite ELF data when the BFD has been opened for update.
6642 abfd->output_has_begun was set to TRUE on opening, so creation of new
6643 sections, and modification of existing section sizes was restricted.
6644 This means the ELF header, program headers and section headers can't have
6645 changed.
6646 If the contents of any sections has been modified, then those changes have
6647 already been written to the BFD. */
6648 else if (abfd->direction == both_direction)
6649 {
6650 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
6651 return TRUE;
6652 }
6653
6654 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6655
6656 failed = FALSE;
6657 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
6658 if (failed)
6659 return FALSE;
6660
6661 if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
6662 return FALSE;
6663
6664 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
6665 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6666 for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
6667 {
6668 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
6669 = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6670 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
6671 if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
6672 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]))
6673 return FALSE;
6674 if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
6675 {
6676 bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
6677
6678 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6679 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
6680 return FALSE;
6681 }
6682 }
6683
6684 /* Write out the section header names. */
6685 t = elf_tdata (abfd);
6686 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
6687 && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6688 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
6689 return FALSE;
6690
6691 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd))
6692 return FALSE;
6693
6694 if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
6695 return FALSE;
6696
6697 /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
6698 if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
6699 return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
6700
6701 return TRUE;
6702}
6703
6704bfd_boolean
6705_bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
6706{
6707 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
6708 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
6709}
6710
6711/* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
6712
6713unsigned int
6714_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
6715{
6716 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6717 unsigned int sec_index;
6718
6719 if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
6720 && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
6721 return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
6722
6723 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
6724 sec_index = SHN_ABS;
6725 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
6726 sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
6727 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
6728 sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
6729 else
6730 sec_index = SHN_BAD;
6731
6732 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6733 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
6734 {
6735 int retval = sec_index;
6736
6737 if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
6738 return retval;
6739 }
6740
6741 if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
6742 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
6743
6744 return sec_index;
6745}
6746
6747/* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
6748 on error. */
6749
6750int
6751_bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
6752{
6753 asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
6754 int idx;
6755 flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
6756
6757 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
6758 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
6759 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
6760 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
6761 input sections rather than the output section. */
6762 if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
6763 && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6764 && asym_ptr->section)
6765 {
6766 asection *sec;
6767 int indx;
6768
6769 sec = asym_ptr->section;
6770 if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
6771 sec = sec->output_section;
6772 if (sec->owner == abfd
6773 && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
6774 && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
6775 asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
6776 }
6777
6778 idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
6779
6780 if (idx == 0)
6781 {
6782 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
6783 which is used in a relocation entry. */
6784 _bfd_error_handler
6785 /* xgettext:c-format */
6786 (_("%pB: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
6787 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
6788 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
6789 return -1;
6790 }
6791
6792#if DEBUG & 4
6793 {
6794 fprintf (stderr,
6795 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8x\n",
6796 (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, flags);
6797 fflush (stderr);
6798 }
6799#endif
6800
6801 return idx;
6802}
6803
6804/* Rewrite program header information. */
6805
6806static bfd_boolean
6807rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6808{
6809 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6810 struct elf_segment_map *map;
6811 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6812 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6813 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6814 asection *section;
6815 unsigned int i;
6816 unsigned int num_segments;
6817 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6818 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6819 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
6820 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
6821 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
6822 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6823 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (ibfd, NULL);
6824
6825 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6826 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6827
6828 map_first = NULL;
6829 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6830
6831 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6832 maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
6833
6834 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
6835#define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
6836 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
6837 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
6838
6839#define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
6840 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6841 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
6842 ? section->size : 0)
6843
6844 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6845 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
6846#define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment, opb) \
6847 (section->vma * (opb) >= segment->p_vaddr \
6848 && (section->vma * (opb) + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6849 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
6850
6851 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6852 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
6853#define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base, opb) \
6854 (section->lma * (opb) >= base \
6855 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) / (opb) >= section->lma) \
6856 && (section->lma * (opb) + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6857 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
6858
6859 /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
6860#define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
6861 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
6862 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
6863 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6864 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6865 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6866
6867 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
6868 etc. */
6869#define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
6870 (IS_NOTE (p, s) \
6871 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6872 && s->vma == 0 \
6873 && s->lma == 0)
6874
6875 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6876 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6877 p_memsz set to 0. */
6878#define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6879 (p->p_vaddr == 0 \
6880 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6881 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6882 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6883 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6884 && s->size > 0 \
6885 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6886 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6887 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6888
6889 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6890 A section will be included if:
6891 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6892 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6893 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6894 segment.
6895 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6896 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6897 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6898 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6899 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6900 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6901 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6902#define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed, opb) \
6903 ((((segment->p_paddr \
6904 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr, opb) \
6905 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment, opb)) \
6906 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6907 || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6908 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6909 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6910 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6911 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6912 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6913 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6914 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6915 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6916 || (segment->p_paddr \
6917 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma * (opb) \
6918 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma * (opb)) \
6919 || (strcmp (bfd_section_name (section), ".dynamic") == 0)) \
6920 && (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD || !section->segment_mark))
6921
6922/* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6923 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6924#define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed, opb) \
6925 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed, opb) \
6926 && section->output_section != NULL)
6927
6928 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6929#define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6930 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6931
6932 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6933 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6934 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6935 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6936 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6937 LMA. */
6938#define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6939 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6940 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6941 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6942 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6943
6944 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6945 for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6946 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6947
6948 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6949 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6950 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6951 don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6952 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6953 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6954 i < num_segments;
6955 i++, segment++)
6956 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6957 {
6958 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6959 break;
6960 }
6961
6962 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6963 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6964 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6965 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6966 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6967 i < num_segments;
6968 i++, segment++)
6969 {
6970 unsigned int j;
6971 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
6972
6973 if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
6974 for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
6975 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
6976 {
6977 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6978 assignment code will work. */
6979 segment->p_vaddr = section->vma * opb;
6980 break;
6981 }
6982
6983 if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6984 {
6985 /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6986 if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6987 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6988 continue;
6989 }
6990
6991 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
6992 for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
6993 {
6994 bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
6995
6996 if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
6997 || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
6998 continue;
6999
7000 /* Merge the two segments together. */
7001 if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
7002 {
7003 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
7004 SEGMENT. */
7005 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
7006 - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
7007
7008 if (extra_length > 0)
7009 {
7010 segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
7011 segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
7012 }
7013
7014 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
7015
7016 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
7017 i = 0;
7018 segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7019 break;
7020 }
7021 else
7022 {
7023 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
7024 SEGMENT2. */
7025 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
7026 - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
7027
7028 if (extra_length > 0)
7029 {
7030 segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
7031 segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
7032 }
7033
7034 segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
7035 }
7036 }
7037 }
7038
7039 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
7040 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7041 i < num_segments;
7042 i++, segment++)
7043 {
7044 unsigned int section_count;
7045 asection **sections;
7046 asection *output_section;
7047 unsigned int isec;
7048 asection *matching_lma;
7049 asection *suggested_lma;
7050 unsigned int j;
7051 size_t amt;
7052 asection *first_section;
7053
7054 if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
7055 continue;
7056
7057 first_section = NULL;
7058 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
7059 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7060 section != NULL;
7061 section = section->next)
7062 {
7063 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
7064 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
7065 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed, opb))
7066 {
7067 if (first_section == NULL)
7068 first_section = section;
7069 if (section->output_section != NULL)
7070 ++section_count;
7071 }
7072 }
7073
7074 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7075 all of the sections we have selected. */
7076 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
7077 amt += section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7078 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7079 if (map == NULL)
7080 return FALSE;
7081
7082 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
7083 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
7084 map->next = NULL;
7085 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7086 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7087 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7088
7089 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
7090 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
7091 output segment. */
7092 if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
7093 {
7094 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7095 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7096 }
7097
7098 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7099 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7100 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7101 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7102 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7103
7104 if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7105 {
7106 map->includes_phdrs =
7107 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7108 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7109 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7110 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7111
7112 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7113 phdr_included = TRUE;
7114 }
7115
7116 if (section_count == 0)
7117 {
7118 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
7119 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
7120 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
7121 a warning is produced.
7122 There is however the valid use case of embedded systems which
7123 have segments with p_filesz of 0 and a p_memsz > 0 to initialize
7124 flash memory with zeros. No warning is shown for that case. */
7125 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7126 && (segment->p_filesz > 0 || segment->p_memsz == 0))
7127 /* xgettext:c-format */
7128 _bfd_error_handler
7129 (_("%pB: warning: empty loadable segment detected"
7130 " at vaddr=%#" PRIx64 ", is this intentional?"),
7131 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_vaddr);
7132
7133 map->p_vaddr_offset = segment->p_vaddr / opb;
7134 map->count = 0;
7135 *pointer_to_map = map;
7136 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7137
7138 continue;
7139 }
7140
7141 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
7142 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
7143 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
7144 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
7145
7146 1. None of the sections have been moved.
7147 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
7148 input BFD.
7149
7150 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
7151 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
7152 of the first section.
7153
7154 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
7155 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
7156 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
7157 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
7158 have to be created to contain the other sections.
7159
7160 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
7161 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
7162 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
7163 or segments to contain the other sections.
7164
7165 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
7166 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
7167 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
7168
7169 amt = section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7170 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc (amt);
7171 if (sections == NULL)
7172 return FALSE;
7173
7174 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
7175 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
7176 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
7177 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
7178 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
7179 more to do. */
7180 isec = 0;
7181 matching_lma = NULL;
7182 suggested_lma = NULL;
7183
7184 for (section = first_section, j = 0;
7185 section != NULL;
7186 section = section->next)
7187 {
7188 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed, opb))
7189 {
7190 output_section = section->output_section;
7191
7192 sections[j++] = section;
7193
7194 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
7195 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
7196 correct value. Note - some backends require that
7197 p_paddr be left as zero. */
7198 if (!p_paddr_valid
7199 && segment->p_vaddr != 0
7200 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
7201 && isec == 0
7202 && output_section->lma != 0
7203 && (align_power (segment->p_vaddr
7204 + (map->includes_filehdr
7205 ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
7206 + (map->includes_phdrs
7207 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
7208 : 0),
7209 output_section->alignment_power * opb)
7210 == (output_section->vma * opb)))
7211 map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
7212
7213 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
7214 LMA address of the output section. */
7215 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr,
7216 opb)
7217 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
7218 || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
7219 && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment, opb)))
7220 {
7221 if (matching_lma == NULL
7222 || output_section->lma < matching_lma->lma)
7223 matching_lma = output_section;
7224
7225 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
7226 then it does not overlap any other section within that
7227 segment. */
7228 map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
7229 }
7230 else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7231 suggested_lma = output_section;
7232
7233 if (j == section_count)
7234 break;
7235 }
7236 }
7237
7238 BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
7239
7240 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
7241 if necessary. */
7242 if (isec == section_count)
7243 {
7244 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
7245 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
7246 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
7247 program header in the input BFD. */
7248 map->count = section_count;
7249 *pointer_to_map = map;
7250 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7251
7252 if (p_paddr_valid
7253 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7254 {
7255 bfd_vma hdr_size = 0;
7256 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7257 hdr_size = iehdr->e_ehsize;
7258 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7259 hdr_size += iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7260
7261 /* Account for padding before the first section in the
7262 segment. */
7263 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((map->p_paddr + hdr_size) / opb
7264 - matching_lma->lma);
7265 }
7266
7267 free (sections);
7268 continue;
7269 }
7270 else
7271 {
7272 /* Change the current segment's physical address to match
7273 the LMA of the first section that fitted, or if no
7274 section fitted, the first section. */
7275 if (matching_lma == NULL)
7276 matching_lma = suggested_lma;
7277
7278 map->p_paddr = matching_lma->lma * opb;
7279
7280 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
7281 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
7282 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7283 {
7284 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7285
7286 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
7287 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
7288 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
7289 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
7290 offset when we know the correct value. */
7291 phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
7292 phdr_adjust_seg = map;
7293 }
7294
7295 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7296 {
7297 bfd_vma align = (bfd_vma) 1 << matching_lma->alignment_power;
7298 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
7299 /* We've subtracted off the size of headers from the
7300 first section lma, but there may have been some
7301 alignment padding before that section too. Try to
7302 account for that by adjusting the segment lma down to
7303 the same alignment. */
7304 if (segment->p_align != 0 && segment->p_align < align)
7305 align = segment->p_align;
7306 map->p_paddr &= -(align * opb);
7307 }
7308 }
7309
7310 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
7311 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
7312 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
7313 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
7314 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
7315 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
7316 the loop. */
7317 isec = 0;
7318 do
7319 {
7320 map->count = 0;
7321 suggested_lma = NULL;
7322
7323 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
7324 for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
7325 {
7326 section = sections[j];
7327
7328 if (section == NULL)
7329 continue;
7330
7331 output_section = section->output_section;
7332
7333 BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
7334
7335 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr,
7336 opb)
7337 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
7338 {
7339 if (map->count == 0)
7340 {
7341 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
7342 the beginning of the segment, then something is
7343 wrong. */
7344 if (align_power (map->p_paddr
7345 + (map->includes_filehdr
7346 ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
7347 + (map->includes_phdrs
7348 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
7349 : 0),
7350 output_section->alignment_power * opb)
7351 != output_section->lma * opb)
7352 goto sorry;
7353 }
7354 else
7355 {
7356 asection *prev_sec;
7357
7358 prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
7359
7360 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
7361 and the start of this section is more than
7362 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
7363 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
7364 maxpagesize)
7365 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
7366 || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
7367 > output_section->lma))
7368 {
7369 if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7370 suggested_lma = output_section;
7371
7372 continue;
7373 }
7374 }
7375
7376 map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
7377 ++isec;
7378 sections[j] = NULL;
7379 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
7380 section->segment_mark = TRUE;
7381 }
7382 else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7383 suggested_lma = output_section;
7384 }
7385
7386 /* PR 23932. A corrupt input file may contain sections that cannot
7387 be assigned to any segment - because for example they have a
7388 negative size - or segments that do not contain any sections.
7389 But there are also valid reasons why a segment can be empty.
7390 So allow a count of zero. */
7391
7392 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
7393 *pointer_to_map = map;
7394 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7395
7396 if (isec < section_count)
7397 {
7398 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
7399 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
7400 and carry on looping. */
7401 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
7402 amt += section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7403 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7404 if (map == NULL)
7405 {
7406 free (sections);
7407 return FALSE;
7408 }
7409
7410 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
7411 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
7412 not yet been assigned. */
7413 map->next = NULL;
7414 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7415 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7416 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7417 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma->lma * opb;
7418 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7419 map->includes_filehdr = 0;
7420 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7421 }
7422
7423 continue;
7424 sorry:
7425 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry);
7426 free (sections);
7427 return FALSE;
7428 }
7429 while (isec < section_count);
7430
7431 free (sections);
7432 }
7433
7434 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7435
7436 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
7437 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
7438 the offset if necessary. */
7439 if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
7440 {
7441 unsigned int count;
7442
7443 for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7444 count++;
7445
7446 if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
7447 phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
7448 -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7449
7450 for (map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7451 if (map->p_type == PT_PHDR)
7452 {
7453 bfd_vma adjust
7454 = phdr_adjust_seg->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0;
7455 map->p_paddr = phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr + adjust;
7456 break;
7457 }
7458 }
7459
7460#undef SEGMENT_END
7461#undef SECTION_SIZE
7462#undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
7463#undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
7464#undef IS_NOTE
7465#undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
7466#undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
7467#undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
7468#undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
7469#undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
7470#undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
7471 return TRUE;
7472}
7473
7474/* Copy ELF program header information. */
7475
7476static bfd_boolean
7477copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7478{
7479 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
7480 struct elf_segment_map *map;
7481 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
7482 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
7483 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7484 unsigned int i;
7485 unsigned int num_segments;
7486 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
7487 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
7488 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (ibfd, NULL);
7489
7490 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
7491
7492 map_first = NULL;
7493 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
7494
7495 /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
7496 map->p_paddr_valid. */
7497 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7498 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7499 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7500 i < num_segments;
7501 i++, segment++)
7502 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
7503 {
7504 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
7505 break;
7506 }
7507
7508 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7509 i < num_segments;
7510 i++, segment++)
7511 {
7512 asection *section;
7513 unsigned int section_count;
7514 size_t amt;
7515 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7516 asection *first_section = NULL;
7517 asection *lowest_section;
7518
7519 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
7520 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7521 section != NULL;
7522 section = section->next)
7523 {
7524 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7525 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7526 {
7527 if (first_section == NULL)
7528 first_section = section;
7529 section_count++;
7530 }
7531 }
7532
7533 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7534 all of the sections we have selected. */
7535 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
7536 amt += section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7537 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7538 if (map == NULL)
7539 return FALSE;
7540
7541 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
7542 input segment. */
7543 map->next = NULL;
7544 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7545 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7546 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7547 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7548 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7549 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
7550 map->p_align_valid = 1;
7551 map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
7552
7553 if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
7554 || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
7555 {
7556 /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
7557 bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
7558 section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
7559 change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
7560 Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
7561 systems. */
7562 map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
7563 map->p_size_valid = 1;
7564 }
7565
7566 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7567 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7568 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7569 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7570
7571 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7572 if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7573 {
7574 map->includes_phdrs =
7575 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7576 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7577 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7578 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7579
7580 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7581 phdr_included = TRUE;
7582 }
7583
7584 lowest_section = NULL;
7585 if (section_count != 0)
7586 {
7587 unsigned int isec = 0;
7588
7589 for (section = first_section;
7590 section != NULL;
7591 section = section->next)
7592 {
7593 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7594 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7595 {
7596 map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
7597 if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7598 {
7599 bfd_vma seg_off;
7600
7601 if (lowest_section == NULL
7602 || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
7603 lowest_section = section;
7604
7605 /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
7606 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
7607 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
7608 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
7609 invalid. */
7610 if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
7611 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
7612 else
7613 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
7614 if (section->lma * opb - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
7615 map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7616 }
7617 if (isec == section_count)
7618 break;
7619 }
7620 }
7621 }
7622
7623 if (section_count == 0)
7624 map->p_vaddr_offset = segment->p_vaddr / opb;
7625 else if (map->p_paddr_valid)
7626 {
7627 /* Account for padding before the first section in the segment. */
7628 bfd_vma hdr_size = 0;
7629 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7630 hdr_size = iehdr->e_ehsize;
7631 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7632 hdr_size += iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7633
7634 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((map->p_paddr + hdr_size) / opb
7635 - (lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0));
7636 }
7637
7638 map->count = section_count;
7639 *pointer_to_map = map;
7640 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7641 }
7642
7643 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7644 return TRUE;
7645}
7646
7647/* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
7648 information. */
7649
7650static bfd_boolean
7651copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7652{
7653 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7654 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7655 return TRUE;
7656
7657 if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
7658 return TRUE;
7659
7660 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7661 {
7662 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
7663 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
7664 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7665 asection *section, *osec;
7666 unsigned int i, num_segments;
7667 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7668 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7669
7670 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
7671
7672 /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
7673 if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7674 goto rewrite;
7675
7676 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
7677 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7678 section = section->next)
7679 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7680
7681 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7682 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7683 i < num_segments;
7684 i++, segment++)
7685 {
7686 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
7687 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
7688 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
7689 map in this case. */
7690 if (segment->p_paddr == 0
7691 && segment->p_memsz == 0
7692 && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
7693 goto rewrite;
7694
7695 for (section = ibfd->sections;
7696 section != NULL; section = section->next)
7697 {
7698 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
7699 from the input BFD. */
7700 osec = section->output_section;
7701 if (osec)
7702 osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
7703
7704 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
7705 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7706 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7707 {
7708 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
7709 removed. What else do we need to check? */
7710 if (osec == NULL
7711 || section->flags != osec->flags
7712 || section->lma != osec->lma
7713 || section->vma != osec->vma
7714 || section->size != osec->size
7715 || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
7716 || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
7717 goto rewrite;
7718 }
7719 }
7720 }
7721
7722 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
7723 input BFD. */
7724 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7725 section = section->next)
7726 {
7727 if (!section->segment_mark)
7728 goto rewrite;
7729 else
7730 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7731 }
7732
7733 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7734 }
7735
7736 rewrite:
7737 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7738 {
7739 /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
7740 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
7741 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7742 unsigned int i;
7743 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7744 bfd_vma maxpagesize = 0;
7745
7746 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7747 i < num_segments;
7748 i++, segment++)
7749 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7750 && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
7751 {
7752 /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
7753 if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
7754 /* xgettext:c-format */
7755 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: warning: segment alignment of %#"
7756 PRIx64 " is too large"),
7757 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_align);
7758 else
7759 maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
7760 }
7761
7762 if (maxpagesize != get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize)
7763 bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd), maxpagesize);
7764 }
7765
7766 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7767}
7768
7769/* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
7770
7771bfd_boolean
7772_bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7773 asection *isec,
7774 bfd *obfd,
7775 asection *osec,
7776 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7777
7778{
7779 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7780 bfd_boolean final_link = (link_info != NULL
7781 && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
7782
7783 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7784 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7785 return TRUE;
7786
7787 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
7788
7789 /* If this is a known ABI section, ELF section type and flags may
7790 have been set up when OSEC was created. For normal sections we
7791 allow the user to override the type and flags other than
7792 SHF_MASKOS and SHF_MASKPROC. */
7793 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_PROGBITS
7794 || elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NOTE
7795 || elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NOBITS)
7796 elf_section_type (osec) = SHT_NULL;
7797 /* For objcopy and relocatable link, copy the ELF section type from
7798 the input file if the BFD section flags are the same. (If they
7799 are different the user may be doing something like
7800 "objcopy --set-section-flags .text=alloc,data".) For a final
7801 link allow some flags that the linker clears to differ. */
7802 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
7803 && (osec->flags == isec->flags
7804 || (final_link
7805 && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
7806 & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
7807 elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
7808
7809 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
7810 elf_section_flags (osec) = (elf_section_flags (isec)
7811 & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
7812
7813 /* Copy sh_info from input for mbind section. */
7814 if ((elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind) != 0
7815 && elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
7816 elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr.sh_info
7817 = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.sh_info;
7818
7819 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
7820 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
7821 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
7822 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
7823 if ((link_info == NULL
7824 || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
7825 && (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
7826 || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0))
7827 {
7828 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
7829 elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
7830 elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7831 elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
7832 }
7833
7834 /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
7835 if (!final_link && (ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
7836 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7837 & SHF_COMPRESSED);
7838
7839 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7840
7841 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
7842 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
7843 may be NULL at this point. */
7844 if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
7845 {
7846 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7847 ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
7848 elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
7849 }
7850
7851 osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
7852
7853 return TRUE;
7854}
7855
7856/* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
7857 field, and sometimes the info field. */
7858
7859bfd_boolean
7860_bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7861 asection *isec,
7862 bfd *obfd,
7863 asection *osec)
7864{
7865 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7866
7867 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7868 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7869 return TRUE;
7870
7871 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7872 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7873
7874 ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
7875
7876 if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
7877 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
7878 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
7879 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
7880 ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
7881
7882 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
7883 NULL);
7884}
7885
7886/* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
7887 necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
7888 the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
7889 output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
7890 function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
7891 from the linker. */
7892
7893bfd_boolean
7894_bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
7895{
7896 asection *isec;
7897
7898 for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
7899 if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
7900 {
7901 asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7902 asection *s = first;
7903 bfd_size_type removed = 0;
7904
7905 while (s != NULL)
7906 {
7907 /* If this member section is being output but the
7908 SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7909 set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7910 if (s->output_section != discarded
7911 && isec->output_section == discarded)
7912 {
7913 elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
7914 elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
7915 }
7916 else
7917 {
7918 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
7919 if (s->output_section == discarded
7920 && isec->output_section != discarded)
7921 {
7922 /* Conversely, if the member section is not being
7923 output but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust
7924 its size. */
7925 removed += 4;
7926 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
7927 && (elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7928 removed += 4;
7929 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
7930 && (elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7931 removed += 4;
7932 }
7933 else
7934 {
7935 /* Also adjust for zero-sized relocation member
7936 section. */
7937 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
7938 && elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_size == 0)
7939 removed += 4;
7940 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
7941 && elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_size == 0)
7942 removed += 4;
7943 }
7944 }
7945 s = elf_next_in_group (s);
7946 if (s == first)
7947 break;
7948 }
7949 if (removed != 0)
7950 {
7951 if (discarded != NULL)
7952 {
7953 /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7954 adjust the input section size. */
7955 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
7956 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
7957 isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
7958 if (isec->size <= 4)
7959 {
7960 isec->size = 0;
7961 isec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7962 }
7963 }
7964 else
7965 {
7966 /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7967 objcopy. */
7968 isec->output_section->size -= removed;
7969 if (isec->output_section->size <= 4)
7970 {
7971 isec->output_section->size = 0;
7972 isec->output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7973 }
7974 }
7975 }
7976 }
7977
7978 return TRUE;
7979}
7980
7981/* Copy private header information. */
7982
7983bfd_boolean
7984_bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7985{
7986 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7987 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7988 return TRUE;
7989
7990 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
7991 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
7992 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
7993 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
7994 already been worked out. */
7995 if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
7996 {
7997 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
7998 return FALSE;
7999 }
8000
8001 return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
8002}
8003
8004/* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
8005 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
8006 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
8007 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
8008 swap_out_syms function. */
8009
8010#define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
8011#define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
8012#define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
8013#define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
8014#define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
8015
8016bfd_boolean
8017_bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
8018 asymbol *isymarg,
8019 bfd *obfd,
8020 asymbol *osymarg)
8021{
8022 elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
8023
8024 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
8025 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
8026 return TRUE;
8027
8028 isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
8029 osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
8030
8031 if (isym != NULL
8032 && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
8033 && osym != NULL
8034 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
8035 {
8036 unsigned int shndx;
8037
8038 shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
8039 if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
8040 shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
8041 else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
8042 shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
8043 else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
8044 shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
8045 else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
8046 shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
8047 else if (find_section_in_list (shndx, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)))
8048 shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
8049 osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
8050 }
8051
8052 return TRUE;
8053}
8054
8055/* Swap out the symbols. */
8056
8057static bfd_boolean
8058swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
8059 struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
8060 int relocatable_p)
8061{
8062 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
8063 unsigned int symcount;
8064 asymbol **syms;
8065 struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
8066 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
8067 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
8068 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
8069 struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
8070 bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
8071 bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
8072 unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
8073 unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
8074 unsigned int idx;
8075 unsigned int num_locals;
8076 size_t amt;
8077 bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
8078
8079 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
8080 return FALSE;
8081
8082 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
8083 stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
8084 if (stt == NULL)
8085 return FALSE;
8086
8087 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8088 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
8089 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8090 symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
8091 symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
8092 symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
8093 symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
8094 symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
8095
8096 symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
8097 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
8098
8099 /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
8100 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount + 1, sizeof (*symstrtab), &amt)
8101 || (symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc (amt)) == NULL)
8102 {
8103 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
8104 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
8105 return FALSE;
8106 }
8107
8108 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount + 1, bed->s->sizeof_sym, &amt)
8109 || (outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt)) == NULL)
8110 {
8111 error_no_mem:
8112 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
8113 error_return:
8114 free (symstrtab);
8115 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
8116 return FALSE;
8117 }
8118 symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
8119 outbound_syms_index = 0;
8120
8121 outbound_shndx = NULL;
8122 outbound_shndx_index = 0;
8123
8124 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
8125 {
8126 symtab_shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
8127 if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
8128 {
8129 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount + 1,
8130 sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx), &amt))
8131 goto error_no_mem;
8132 outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8133 if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
8134 goto error_return;
8135
8136 symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
8137 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
8138 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
8139 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
8140 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
8141 }
8142 /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ? */
8143 }
8144
8145 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
8146 {
8147 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
8148 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
8149 sym.st_name = 0;
8150 sym.st_value = 0;
8151 sym.st_size = 0;
8152 sym.st_info = 0;
8153 sym.st_other = 0;
8154 sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
8155 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
8156 symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
8157 symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
8158 symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
8159 outbound_syms_index++;
8160 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
8161 outbound_shndx_index++;
8162 }
8163
8164 name_local_sections
8165 = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
8166 && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
8167
8168 syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
8169 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
8170 {
8171 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
8172 bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
8173 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
8174 flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
8175 int type;
8176
8177 if (!name_local_sections
8178 && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
8179 {
8180 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
8181 sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
8182 }
8183 else
8184 {
8185 /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
8186 to get the final offset for st_name. */
8187 sym.st_name
8188 = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
8189 FALSE);
8190 if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
8191 goto error_return;
8192 }
8193
8194 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
8195
8196 if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
8197 && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
8198 {
8199 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
8200 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
8201 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
8202 sym.st_size = value;
8203 if (type_ptr == NULL
8204 || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
8205 sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
8206 else
8207 sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
8208 sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
8209 (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
8210 }
8211 else
8212 {
8213 asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
8214 unsigned int shndx;
8215
8216 if (sec->output_section)
8217 {
8218 value += sec->output_offset;
8219 sec = sec->output_section;
8220 }
8221
8222 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
8223 if (! relocatable_p)
8224 value += sec->vma;
8225 sym.st_value = value;
8226 sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
8227
8228 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
8229 && type_ptr != NULL
8230 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
8231 {
8232 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
8233 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
8234 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
8235 shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
8236 switch (shndx)
8237 {
8238 case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
8239 shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
8240 break;
8241 case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
8242 shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
8243 break;
8244 case MAP_STRTAB:
8245 shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
8246 break;
8247 case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
8248 shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
8249 break;
8250 case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
8251 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
8252 shndx = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx;
8253 break;
8254 case SHN_COMMON:
8255 case SHN_ABS:
8256 shndx = SHN_ABS;
8257 break;
8258 default:
8259 if (shndx >= SHN_LOPROC && shndx <= SHN_HIOS)
8260 {
8261 if (bed->symbol_section_index)
8262 shndx = bed->symbol_section_index (abfd, type_ptr);
8263 /* Otherwise just leave the index alone. */
8264 }
8265 else
8266 {
8267 if (shndx > SHN_HIOS && shndx < SHN_HIRESERVE)
8268 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: \
8269Unable to handle section index %x in ELF symbol. Using ABS instead."),
8270 abfd, shndx);
8271 shndx = SHN_ABS;
8272 }
8273 break;
8274 }
8275 }
8276 else
8277 {
8278 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
8279
8280 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
8281 {
8282 asection *sec2;
8283
8284 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
8285 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
8286 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
8287 demand of applications. For example, it
8288 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
8289 section of a symbol to be a section that is
8290 actually in the output file. */
8291 sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
8292 if (sec2 != NULL)
8293 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
8294 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
8295 {
8296 /* xgettext:c-format */
8297 _bfd_error_handler
8298 (_("unable to find equivalent output section"
8299 " for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
8300 syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
8301 sec->name);
8302 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8303 goto error_return;
8304 }
8305 }
8306 }
8307
8308 sym.st_shndx = shndx;
8309 }
8310
8311 if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8312 type = STT_TLS;
8313 else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
8314 type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
8315 else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
8316 type = STT_FUNC;
8317 else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
8318 type = STT_OBJECT;
8319 else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
8320 type = STT_RELC;
8321 else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
8322 type = STT_SRELC;
8323 else
8324 type = STT_NOTYPE;
8325
8326 if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
8327 type = STT_TLS;
8328
8329 /* Processor-specific types. */
8330 if (type_ptr != NULL
8331 && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8332 type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8333 (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
8334
8335 if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
8336 {
8337 if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8338 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8339 else
8340 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
8341 }
8342 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
8343 {
8344 if (type != STT_TLS)
8345 {
8346 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_CONVERT_ELF_COMMON))
8347 type = ((abfd->flags & BFD_USE_ELF_STT_COMMON)
8348 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8349 else
8350 type = ((flags & BSF_ELF_COMMON) != 0
8351 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8352 }
8353 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
8354 }
8355 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
8356 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
8357 ? STB_WEAK
8358 : STB_GLOBAL),
8359 type);
8360 else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
8361 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
8362 else
8363 {
8364 int bind = STB_LOCAL;
8365
8366 if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
8367 bind = STB_LOCAL;
8368 else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
8369 bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
8370 else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
8371 bind = STB_WEAK;
8372 else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8373 bind = STB_GLOBAL;
8374
8375 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
8376 }
8377
8378 if (type_ptr != NULL)
8379 {
8380 sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
8381 sym.st_target_internal
8382 = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
8383 }
8384 else
8385 {
8386 sym.st_other = 0;
8387 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
8388 }
8389
8390 idx++;
8391 symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
8392 symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
8393 symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
8394
8395 outbound_syms_index++;
8396 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
8397 outbound_shndx_index++;
8398 }
8399
8400 /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
8401 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
8402
8403 /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
8404 for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
8405 {
8406 struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
8407 if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
8408 elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
8409 else
8410 elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
8411 elfsym->sym.st_name);
8412 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
8413 (outbound_syms
8414 + (elfsym->dest_index
8415 * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
8416 (outbound_shndx
8417 + (elfsym->destshndx_index
8418 * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
8419 }
8420 free (symstrtab);
8421
8422 *sttp = stt;
8423 symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
8424 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
8425 symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
8426 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
8427 symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
8428 symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
8429 symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
8430 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
8431
8432 return TRUE;
8433}
8434
8435/* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
8436
8437 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
8438 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
8439 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
8440
8441long
8442_bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8443{
8444 bfd_size_type symcount;
8445 long symtab_size;
8446 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8447
8448 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8449 if (symcount > LONG_MAX / sizeof (asymbol *))
8450 {
8451 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8452 return -1;
8453 }
8454 symtab_size = symcount * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8455 if (symcount == 0)
8456 symtab_size = sizeof (asymbol *);
8457 else if (!bfd_write_p (abfd))
8458 {
8459 ufile_ptr filesize = bfd_get_file_size (abfd);
8460
8461 if (filesize != 0 && (unsigned long) symtab_size > filesize)
8462 {
8463 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
8464 return -1;
8465 }
8466 }
8467
8468 return symtab_size;
8469}
8470
8471long
8472_bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8473{
8474 bfd_size_type symcount;
8475 long symtab_size;
8476 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
8477
8478 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8479 {
8480 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8481 return -1;
8482 }
8483
8484 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8485 if (symcount > LONG_MAX / sizeof (asymbol *))
8486 {
8487 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8488 return -1;
8489 }
8490 symtab_size = symcount * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8491 if (symcount == 0)
8492 symtab_size = sizeof (asymbol *);
8493 else if (!bfd_write_p (abfd))
8494 {
8495 ufile_ptr filesize = bfd_get_file_size (abfd);
8496
8497 if (filesize != 0 && (unsigned long) symtab_size > filesize)
8498 {
8499 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
8500 return -1;
8501 }
8502 }
8503
8504 return symtab_size;
8505}
8506
8507long
8508_bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr asect)
8509{
8510 if (asect->reloc_count != 0 && !bfd_write_p (abfd))
8511 {
8512 /* Sanity check reloc section size. */
8513 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d = elf_section_data (asect);
8514 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr = &d->this_hdr;
8515 bfd_size_type ext_rel_size = rel_hdr->sh_size;
8516 ufile_ptr filesize = bfd_get_file_size (abfd);
8517
8518 if (filesize != 0 && ext_rel_size > filesize)
8519 {
8520 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
8521 return -1;
8522 }
8523 }
8524
8525#if SIZEOF_LONG == SIZEOF_INT
8526 if (asect->reloc_count >= LONG_MAX / sizeof (arelent *))
8527 {
8528 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8529 return -1;
8530 }
8531#endif
8532 return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
8533}
8534
8535/* Canonicalize the relocs. */
8536
8537long
8538_bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8539 sec_ptr section,
8540 arelent **relptr,
8541 asymbol **symbols)
8542{
8543 arelent *tblptr;
8544 unsigned int i;
8545 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8546
8547 if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
8548 return -1;
8549
8550 tblptr = section->relocation;
8551 for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
8552 *relptr++ = tblptr++;
8553
8554 *relptr = NULL;
8555
8556 return section->reloc_count;
8557}
8558
8559long
8560_bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
8561{
8562 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8563 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
8564
8565 if (symcount >= 0)
8566 abfd->symcount = symcount;
8567 return symcount;
8568}
8569
8570long
8571_bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
8572 asymbol **allocation)
8573{
8574 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8575 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
8576
8577 if (symcount >= 0)
8578 abfd->dynsymcount = symcount;
8579 return symcount;
8580}
8581
8582/* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
8583 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
8584 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
8585 dynamic reloc section. */
8586
8587long
8588_bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8589{
8590 bfd_size_type count, ext_rel_size;
8591 asection *s;
8592
8593 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8594 {
8595 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8596 return -1;
8597 }
8598
8599 count = 1;
8600 ext_rel_size = 0;
8601 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8602 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8603 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8604 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8605 {
8606 ext_rel_size += s->size;
8607 if (ext_rel_size < s->size)
8608 {
8609 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
8610 return -1;
8611 }
8612 count += s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8613 if (count > LONG_MAX / sizeof (arelent *))
8614 {
8615 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8616 return -1;
8617 }
8618 }
8619 if (count > 1 && !bfd_write_p (abfd))
8620 {
8621 /* Sanity check reloc section sizes. */
8622 ufile_ptr filesize = bfd_get_file_size (abfd);
8623 if (filesize != 0 && ext_rel_size > filesize)
8624 {
8625 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
8626 return -1;
8627 }
8628 }
8629 return count * sizeof (arelent *);
8630}
8631
8632/* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
8633 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
8634 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
8635 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
8636 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
8637 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
8638 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
8639
8640long
8641_bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8642 arelent **storage,
8643 asymbol **syms)
8644{
8645 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
8646 asection *s;
8647 long ret;
8648
8649 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8650 {
8651 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8652 return -1;
8653 }
8654
8655 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
8656 ret = 0;
8657 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8658 {
8659 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8660 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8661 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8662 {
8663 arelent *p;
8664 long count, i;
8665
8666 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
8667 return -1;
8668 count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8669 p = s->relocation;
8670 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
8671 *storage++ = p++;
8672 ret += count;
8673 }
8674 }
8675
8676 *storage = NULL;
8677
8678 return ret;
8679}
8680\f
8681/* Read in the version information. */
8682
8683bfd_boolean
8684_bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
8685{
8686 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
8687 unsigned int freeidx = 0;
8688 size_t amt;
8689
8690 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
8691 {
8692 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8693 Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
8694 Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
8695 unsigned int i;
8696 bfd_byte *contents_end;
8697
8698 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
8699
8700 if (hdr->sh_info == 0
8701 || hdr->sh_info > hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
8702 {
8703 error_return_bad_verref:
8704 _bfd_error_handler
8705 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
8706 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8707 error_return_verref:
8708 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
8709 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
8710 goto error_return;
8711 }
8712
8713 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
8714 goto error_return_verref;
8715 contents = _bfd_malloc_and_read (abfd, hdr->sh_size, hdr->sh_size);
8716 if (contents == NULL)
8717 goto error_return_verref;
8718
8719 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed), &amt))
8720 {
8721 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8722 goto error_return_verref;
8723 }
8724 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
8725 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
8726 goto error_return_verref;
8727
8728 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
8729 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
8730 contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
8731 everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
8732 iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
8733 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
8734 {
8735 Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
8736 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
8737 unsigned int j;
8738
8739 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
8740
8741 iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
8742
8743 iverneed->vn_filename =
8744 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8745 iverneed->vn_file);
8746 if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
8747 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8748
8749 if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
8750 iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
8751 else
8752 {
8753 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (iverneed->vn_cnt,
8754 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux), &amt))
8755 {
8756 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8757 goto error_return_verref;
8758 }
8759 iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
8760 bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
8761 if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
8762 goto error_return_verref;
8763 }
8764
8765 if (iverneed->vn_aux
8766 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8767 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8768
8769 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8770 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
8771 ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
8772 for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
8773 {
8774 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
8775
8776 ivernaux->vna_nodename =
8777 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8778 ivernaux->vna_name);
8779 if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
8780 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8781
8782 if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
8783 freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
8784
8785 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
8786 if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
8787 {
8788 iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
8789 break;
8790 }
8791 if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
8792 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
8793
8794 if (ivernaux->vna_next
8795 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
8796 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8797
8798 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8799 ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
8800 }
8801
8802 iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
8803 if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
8804 break;
8805 if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
8806 iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
8807
8808 if (iverneed->vn_next
8809 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8810 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8811
8812 everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
8813 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
8814 }
8815 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
8816
8817 free (contents);
8818 contents = NULL;
8819 }
8820
8821 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
8822 {
8823 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8824 Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
8825 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8826 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
8827 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
8828 unsigned int i;
8829 unsigned int maxidx;
8830 bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
8831
8832 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
8833
8834 if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
8835 {
8836 error_return_bad_verdef:
8837 _bfd_error_handler
8838 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
8839 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8840 error_return_verdef:
8841 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
8842 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
8843 goto error_return;
8844 }
8845
8846 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
8847 goto error_return_verdef;
8848 contents = _bfd_malloc_and_read (abfd, hdr->sh_size, hdr->sh_size);
8849 if (contents == NULL)
8850 goto error_return_verdef;
8851
8852 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
8853 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
8854 contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
8855 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
8856 contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
8857 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
8858
8859 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
8860 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
8861 the maximum. */
8862 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8863 maxidx = 0;
8864 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
8865 {
8866 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8867
8868 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
8869 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8870 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
8871 maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
8872
8873 if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
8874 break;
8875
8876 if (iverdefmem.vd_next
8877 > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8878 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8879
8880 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8881 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
8882 }
8883
8884 if (default_imported_symver)
8885 {
8886 if (freeidx > maxidx)
8887 maxidx = ++freeidx;
8888 else
8889 freeidx = ++maxidx;
8890 }
8891 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef), &amt))
8892 {
8893 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8894 goto error_return_verdef;
8895 }
8896 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8897 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8898 goto error_return_verdef;
8899
8900 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
8901
8902 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8903 iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
8904 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
8905 {
8906 Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
8907 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8908 unsigned int j;
8909
8910 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8911
8912 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
8913 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8914
8915 iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
8916 memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
8917
8918 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8919
8920 if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
8921 iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
8922 else
8923 {
8924 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (iverdef->vd_cnt,
8925 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux), &amt))
8926 {
8927 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8928 goto error_return_verdef;
8929 }
8930 iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8931 bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
8932 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8933 goto error_return_verdef;
8934 }
8935
8936 if (iverdef->vd_aux
8937 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8938 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8939
8940 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8941 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
8942 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8943 for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
8944 {
8945 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
8946
8947 iverdaux->vda_nodename =
8948 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8949 iverdaux->vda_name);
8950 if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
8951 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8952
8953 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
8954 if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
8955 {
8956 iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
8957 break;
8958 }
8959 if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
8960 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
8961
8962 if (iverdaux->vda_next
8963 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
8964 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8965
8966 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8967 ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
8968 }
8969
8970 iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
8971 if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
8972 iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
8973
8974 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8975 if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
8976 break;
8977 if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
8978 iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
8979
8980 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8981 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
8982 }
8983
8984 free (contents);
8985 contents = NULL;
8986 }
8987 else if (default_imported_symver)
8988 {
8989 if (freeidx < 3)
8990 freeidx = 3;
8991 else
8992 freeidx++;
8993
8994 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef), &amt))
8995 {
8996 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8997 goto error_return;
8998 }
8999 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9000 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
9001 goto error_return;
9002
9003 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
9004 }
9005
9006 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
9007 if (default_imported_symver)
9008 {
9009 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
9010 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
9011
9012 iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
9013
9014 iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
9015 iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
9016 iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
9017 iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
9018
9019 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
9020
9021 iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
9022 if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
9023 goto error_return_verdef;
9024 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
9025 iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
9026 bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
9027 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
9028 goto error_return_verdef;
9029
9030 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
9031 iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
9032 }
9033
9034 return TRUE;
9035
9036 error_return:
9037 free (contents);
9038 return FALSE;
9039}
9040\f
9041asymbol *
9042_bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
9043{
9044 elf_symbol_type *newsym;
9045
9046 newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*newsym));
9047 if (!newsym)
9048 return NULL;
9049 newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
9050 return &newsym->symbol;
9051}
9052
9053void
9054_bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9055 asymbol *symbol,
9056 symbol_info *ret)
9057{
9058 bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
9059}
9060
9061/* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
9062 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
9063 override it. */
9064
9065bfd_boolean
9066_bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9067 const char *name)
9068{
9069 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
9070 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
9071 return TRUE;
9072
9073 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
9074 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
9075 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
9076 return TRUE;
9077
9078 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
9079 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
9080 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
9081 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
9082 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
9083 we treat such symbols as local. */
9084 if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
9085 return TRUE;
9086
9087 /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
9088 forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
9089 These labels have the form:
9090
9091 L0^A.* (fake symbols)
9092
9093 [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
9094
9095 Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
9096 so we only need to match the rest. */
9097 if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
9098 {
9099 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
9100 const char * p;
9101 char c;
9102
9103 for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
9104 {
9105 if (c == 1 || c == 2)
9106 {
9107 if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
9108 /* A fake symbol. */
9109 return TRUE;
9110
9111 /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
9112 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
9113 assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
9114 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
9115 other than some kind of local ? */
9116 ret = TRUE;
9117 }
9118
9119 if (! ISDIGIT (c))
9120 {
9121 ret = FALSE;
9122 break;
9123 }
9124 }
9125 return ret;
9126 }
9127
9128 return FALSE;
9129}
9130
9131alent *
9132_bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9133 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9134{
9135 abort ();
9136 return NULL;
9137}
9138
9139bfd_boolean
9140_bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
9141 enum bfd_architecture arch,
9142 unsigned long machine)
9143{
9144 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
9145 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
9146 if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
9147 && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
9148 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
9149 return FALSE;
9150
9151 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
9152}
9153
9154/* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
9155 for error reporting. */
9156
9157bfd_boolean
9158_bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
9159 asymbol **symbols,
9160 asection *section,
9161 bfd_vma offset,
9162 const char **filename_ptr,
9163 const char **functionname_ptr,
9164 unsigned int *line_ptr,
9165 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
9166{
9167 bfd_boolean found;
9168
9169 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
9170 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9171 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
9172 dwarf_debug_sections,
9173 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
9174 return TRUE;
9175
9176 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9177 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr, line_ptr))
9178 {
9179 if (!*functionname_ptr)
9180 _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9181 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
9182 functionname_ptr);
9183 return TRUE;
9184 }
9185
9186 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9187 &found, filename_ptr,
9188 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
9189 &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
9190 return FALSE;
9191 if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
9192 return TRUE;
9193
9194 if (symbols == NULL)
9195 return FALSE;
9196
9197 if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9198 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
9199 return FALSE;
9200
9201 *line_ptr = 0;
9202 return TRUE;
9203}
9204
9205/* Find the line for a symbol. */
9206
9207bfd_boolean
9208_bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
9209 const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
9210{
9211 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
9212 filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
9213 dwarf_debug_sections,
9214 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9215}
9216
9217/* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
9218 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
9219 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
9220 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
9221 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
9222
9223bfd_boolean
9224_bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
9225 const char **filename_ptr,
9226 const char **functionname_ptr,
9227 unsigned int *line_ptr)
9228{
9229 bfd_boolean found;
9230 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
9231 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
9232 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9233 return found;
9234}
9235
9236int
9237_bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
9238{
9239 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9240 int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
9241
9242 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
9243 {
9244 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
9245
9246 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
9247 {
9248 struct elf_segment_map *m;
9249
9250 phdr_size = 0;
9251 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
9252 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
9253
9254 if (phdr_size == 0)
9255 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
9256 }
9257
9258 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
9259 ret += phdr_size;
9260 }
9261
9262 return ret;
9263}
9264
9265bfd_boolean
9266_bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
9267 sec_ptr section,
9268 const void *location,
9269 file_ptr offset,
9270 bfd_size_type count)
9271{
9272 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
9273 file_ptr pos;
9274
9275 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
9276 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
9277 return FALSE;
9278
9279 if (!count)
9280 return TRUE;
9281
9282 hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
9283 if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
9284 {
9285 unsigned char *contents;
9286
9287 if (bfd_section_is_ctf (section))
9288 /* Nothing to do with this section: the contents are generated
9289 later. */
9290 return TRUE;
9291
9292 if ((section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0)
9293 {
9294 _bfd_error_handler
9295 (_("%pB:%pA: error: attempting to write into an unallocated compressed section"),
9296 abfd, section);
9297 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
9298 return FALSE;
9299 }
9300
9301 if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size)
9302 {
9303 _bfd_error_handler
9304 (_("%pB:%pA: error: attempting to write over the end of the section"),
9305 abfd, section);
9306
9307 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
9308 return FALSE;
9309 }
9310
9311 contents = hdr->contents;
9312 if (contents == NULL)
9313 {
9314 _bfd_error_handler
9315 (_("%pB:%pA: error: attempting to write section into an empty buffer"),
9316 abfd, section);
9317
9318 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
9319 return FALSE;
9320 }
9321
9322 memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
9323 return TRUE;
9324 }
9325
9326 pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
9327 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
9328 || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
9329 return FALSE;
9330
9331 return TRUE;
9332}
9333
9334bfd_boolean
9335_bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9336 arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9337 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9338{
9339 abort ();
9340 return FALSE;
9341}
9342
9343/* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
9344
9345bfd_boolean
9346_bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
9347{
9348 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
9349
9350 if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
9351 {
9352 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
9353 reloc_howto_type *howto;
9354
9355 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
9356 equivalent ELF reloc. */
9357
9358 if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
9359 {
9360 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
9361 {
9362 case 8:
9363 code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
9364 break;
9365 case 12:
9366 code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
9367 break;
9368 case 16:
9369 code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
9370 break;
9371 case 24:
9372 code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
9373 break;
9374 case 32:
9375 code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
9376 break;
9377 case 64:
9378 code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
9379 break;
9380 default:
9381 goto fail;
9382 }
9383
9384 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
9385
9386 if (howto && areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
9387 {
9388 if (howto->pcrel_offset)
9389 areloc->addend += areloc->address;
9390 else
9391 areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
9392 }
9393 }
9394 else
9395 {
9396 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
9397 {
9398 case 8:
9399 code = BFD_RELOC_8;
9400 break;
9401 case 14:
9402 code = BFD_RELOC_14;
9403 break;
9404 case 16:
9405 code = BFD_RELOC_16;
9406 break;
9407 case 26:
9408 code = BFD_RELOC_26;
9409 break;
9410 case 32:
9411 code = BFD_RELOC_32;
9412 break;
9413 case 64:
9414 code = BFD_RELOC_64;
9415 break;
9416 default:
9417 goto fail;
9418 }
9419
9420 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
9421 }
9422
9423 if (howto)
9424 areloc->howto = howto;
9425 else
9426 goto fail;
9427 }
9428
9429 return TRUE;
9430
9431 fail:
9432 /* xgettext:c-format */
9433 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
9434 abfd, areloc->howto->name);
9435 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry);
9436 return FALSE;
9437}
9438
9439bfd_boolean
9440_bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
9441{
9442 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
9443 if (tdata != NULL
9444 && (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object
9445 || bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
9446 {
9447 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
9448 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
9449 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9450 }
9451
9452 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
9453}
9454
9455/* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
9456 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
9457 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
9458 this reloc. */
9459
9460bfd_reloc_status_type
9461_bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
9462 (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9463 struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9464 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9465 bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9466{
9467 return bfd_reloc_ok;
9468}
9469\f
9470/* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
9471 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
9472 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
9473 out details about the corefile. */
9474
9475#ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
9476# include <sys/procfs.h>
9477#endif
9478
9479/* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
9480 PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
9481
9482static int
9483elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
9484{
9485 int pid;
9486
9487 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
9488 if (pid == 0)
9489 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
9490
9491 return pid;
9492}
9493
9494/* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
9495 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
9496 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
9497 overwrite it. */
9498
9499static bfd_boolean
9500elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
9501{
9502 asection *sect2;
9503
9504 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
9505 return TRUE;
9506
9507 sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
9508 if (sect2 == NULL)
9509 return FALSE;
9510
9511 sect2->size = sect->size;
9512 sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
9513 sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
9514 return TRUE;
9515}
9516
9517/* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
9518 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
9519 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
9520 such a section already exists.
9521 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
9522 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
9523 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
9524bfd_boolean
9525_bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9526 char *name,
9527 size_t size,
9528 ufile_ptr filepos)
9529{
9530 char buf[100];
9531 char *threaded_name;
9532 size_t len;
9533 asection *sect;
9534
9535 /* Build the section name. */
9536
9537 sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9538 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9539 threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9540 if (threaded_name == NULL)
9541 return FALSE;
9542 memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
9543
9544 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
9545 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9546 if (sect == NULL)
9547 return FALSE;
9548 sect->size = size;
9549 sect->filepos = filepos;
9550 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9551
9552 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
9553}
9554
9555static bfd_boolean
9556elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note,
9557 size_t offs)
9558{
9559 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
9560 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9561
9562 if (sect == NULL)
9563 return FALSE;
9564
9565 sect->size = note->descsz - offs;
9566 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offs;
9567 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9568
9569 return TRUE;
9570}
9571
9572/* prstatus_t exists on:
9573 solaris 2.5+
9574 linux 2.[01] + glibc
9575 unixware 4.2
9576*/
9577
9578#if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9579
9580static bfd_boolean
9581elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9582{
9583 size_t size;
9584 int offset;
9585
9586 if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
9587 {
9588 prstatus_t prstat;
9589
9590 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9591 offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
9592 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9593
9594 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9595 has already been set by another thread. */
9596 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9597 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9598 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9599 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9600
9601 /* pr_who exists on:
9602 solaris 2.5+
9603 unixware 4.2
9604 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9605 linux 2.[01]
9606 */
9607#if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
9608 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9609#else
9610 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9611#endif
9612 }
9613#if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9614 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
9615 {
9616 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9617 prstatus32_t prstat;
9618
9619 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9620 offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
9621 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9622
9623 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9624 has already been set by another thread. */
9625 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9626 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9627 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9628 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9629
9630 /* pr_who exists on:
9631 solaris 2.5+
9632 unixware 4.2
9633 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9634 linux 2.[01]
9635 */
9636#if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
9637 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9638#else
9639 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9640#endif
9641 }
9642#endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
9643 else
9644 {
9645 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9646 note size (ie. data object type). */
9647 return TRUE;
9648 }
9649
9650 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9651 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
9652 size, note->descpos + offset);
9653}
9654#endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
9655
9656/* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
9657static bfd_boolean
9658elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9659 char *name,
9660 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9661{
9662 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
9663 note->descsz, note->descpos);
9664}
9665
9666/* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
9667 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
9668 data structure apart. */
9669
9670static bfd_boolean
9671elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9672{
9673 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9674}
9675
9676/* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
9677 type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
9678 literally. */
9679
9680static bfd_boolean
9681elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9682{
9683 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
9684}
9685
9686/* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
9687 with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
9688 contents literally. */
9689
9690static bfd_boolean
9691elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9692{
9693 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
9694}
9695
9696static bfd_boolean
9697elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9698{
9699 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
9700}
9701
9702static bfd_boolean
9703elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9704{
9705 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
9706}
9707
9708static bfd_boolean
9709elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9710{
9711 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tar", note);
9712}
9713
9714static bfd_boolean
9715elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9716{
9717 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-ppr", note);
9718}
9719
9720static bfd_boolean
9721elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9722{
9723 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-dscr", note);
9724}
9725
9726static bfd_boolean
9727elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9728{
9729 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-ebb", note);
9730}
9731
9732static bfd_boolean
9733elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9734{
9735 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-pmu", note);
9736}
9737
9738static bfd_boolean
9739elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9740{
9741 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr", note);
9742}
9743
9744static bfd_boolean
9745elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9746{
9747 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr", note);
9748}
9749
9750static bfd_boolean
9751elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9752{
9753 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx", note);
9754}
9755
9756static bfd_boolean
9757elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9758{
9759 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx", note);
9760}
9761
9762static bfd_boolean
9763elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9764{
9765 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr", note);
9766}
9767
9768static bfd_boolean
9769elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9770{
9771 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar", note);
9772}
9773
9774static bfd_boolean
9775elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9776{
9777 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr", note);
9778}
9779
9780static bfd_boolean
9781elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9782{
9783 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr", note);
9784}
9785
9786static bfd_boolean
9787elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9788{
9789 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
9790}
9791
9792static bfd_boolean
9793elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9794{
9795 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
9796}
9797
9798static bfd_boolean
9799elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9800{
9801 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
9802}
9803
9804static bfd_boolean
9805elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9806{
9807 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
9808}
9809
9810static bfd_boolean
9811elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9812{
9813 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
9814}
9815
9816static bfd_boolean
9817elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9818{
9819 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
9820}
9821
9822static bfd_boolean
9823elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9824{
9825 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
9826}
9827
9828static bfd_boolean
9829elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9830{
9831 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
9832}
9833
9834static bfd_boolean
9835elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9836{
9837 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
9838}
9839
9840static bfd_boolean
9841elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9842{
9843 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
9844}
9845
9846static bfd_boolean
9847elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9848{
9849 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
9850}
9851
9852static bfd_boolean
9853elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9854{
9855 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-cb", note);
9856}
9857
9858static bfd_boolean
9859elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9860{
9861 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-bc", note);
9862}
9863
9864static bfd_boolean
9865elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9866{
9867 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
9868}
9869
9870static bfd_boolean
9871elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9872{
9873 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
9874}
9875
9876static bfd_boolean
9877elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9878{
9879 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
9880}
9881
9882static bfd_boolean
9883elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9884{
9885 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
9886}
9887
9888static bfd_boolean
9889elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9890{
9891 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-sve", note);
9892}
9893
9894static bfd_boolean
9895elfcore_grok_aarch_pauth (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9896{
9897 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-pauth", note);
9898}
9899
9900static bfd_boolean
9901elfcore_grok_arc_v2 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9902{
9903 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arc-v2", note);
9904}
9905
9906#if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
9907typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9908#if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9909typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9910#endif
9911#endif
9912
9913#if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9914typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9915#if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9916typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9917#endif
9918#endif
9919
9920/* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
9921 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
9922 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
9923
9924char *
9925_bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
9926{
9927 char *dups;
9928 char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
9929 size_t len;
9930
9931 if (end == NULL)
9932 len = max;
9933 else
9934 len = end - start;
9935
9936 dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
9937 if (dups == NULL)
9938 return NULL;
9939
9940 memcpy (dups, start, len);
9941 dups[len] = '\0';
9942
9943 return dups;
9944}
9945
9946#if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9947static bfd_boolean
9948elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9949{
9950 if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
9951 {
9952 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
9953
9954 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9955
9956#if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
9957 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9958#endif
9959 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9960 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9961 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9962
9963 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9964 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9965 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9966 }
9967#if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9968 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
9969 {
9970 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9971 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
9972
9973 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9974
9975#if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
9976 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9977#endif
9978 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9979 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9980 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9981
9982 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9983 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9984 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9985 }
9986#endif
9987
9988 else
9989 {
9990 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9991 note size (ie. data object type). */
9992 return TRUE;
9993 }
9994
9995 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
9996 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
9997 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
9998
9999 {
10000 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
10001 int n = strlen (command);
10002
10003 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
10004 command[n - 1] = '\0';
10005 }
10006
10007 return TRUE;
10008}
10009#endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
10010
10011#if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10012static bfd_boolean
10013elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10014{
10015 if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
10016#if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
10017 || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
10018#endif
10019 )
10020 {
10021 pstatus_t pstat;
10022
10023 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
10024
10025 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
10026 }
10027#if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
10028 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
10029 {
10030 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
10031 pstatus32_t pstat;
10032
10033 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
10034
10035 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
10036 }
10037#endif
10038 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
10039 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
10040 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
10041
10042 return TRUE;
10043}
10044#endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
10045
10046#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10047static bfd_boolean
10048elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10049{
10050 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
10051 char buf[100];
10052 char *name;
10053 size_t len;
10054 asection *sect;
10055
10056 if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
10057#if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
10058 && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
10059#endif
10060 )
10061 return TRUE;
10062
10063 memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
10064
10065 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
10066 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
10067 another thread. */
10068 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
10069 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
10070
10071 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
10072
10073 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
10074 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10075 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10076 if (name == NULL)
10077 return FALSE;
10078 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10079
10080 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10081 if (sect == NULL)
10082 return FALSE;
10083
10084#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10085 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
10086 sect->filepos = note->descpos
10087 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
10088#endif
10089
10090#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
10091 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
10092 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
10093#endif
10094
10095 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10096
10097 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
10098 return FALSE;
10099
10100 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
10101
10102 sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
10103 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10104 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10105 if (name == NULL)
10106 return FALSE;
10107 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10108
10109 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10110 if (sect == NULL)
10111 return FALSE;
10112
10113#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10114 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
10115 sect->filepos = note->descpos
10116 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
10117#endif
10118
10119#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
10120 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
10121 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
10122#endif
10123
10124 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10125
10126 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
10127}
10128#endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
10129
10130/* These constants, and the structure offsets used below, are defined by
10131 Cygwin's core_dump.h */
10132#define NOTE_INFO_PROCESS 1
10133#define NOTE_INFO_THREAD 2
10134#define NOTE_INFO_MODULE 3
10135#define NOTE_INFO_MODULE64 4
10136
10137static bfd_boolean
10138elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10139{
10140 char buf[30];
10141 char *name;
10142 size_t len;
10143 size_t name_size;
10144 asection *sect;
10145 int type;
10146 int is_active_thread;
10147 bfd_vma base_addr;
10148
10149 if (note->descsz < 4)
10150 return TRUE;
10151
10152 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
10153 return TRUE;
10154
10155 type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
10156
10157 switch (type)
10158 {
10159 case NOTE_INFO_PROCESS:
10160 if (note->descsz < 12)
10161 return FALSE;
10162
10163 /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
10164 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
10165 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
10166 break;
10167
10168 case NOTE_INFO_THREAD:
10169 if (note->descsz < 12)
10170 return FALSE;
10171
10172 /* Make a ".reg/<tid>" section containing the Win32 API thread CONTEXT
10173 structure. */
10174 /* thread_info.tid */
10175 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4));
10176
10177 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10178 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10179 if (name == NULL)
10180 return FALSE;
10181
10182 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10183
10184 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10185 if (sect == NULL)
10186 return FALSE;
10187
10188 /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
10189 sect->size = note->descsz - 12;
10190 /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
10191 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
10192 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10193
10194 /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
10195 is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
10196
10197 if (is_active_thread)
10198 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
10199 return FALSE;
10200 break;
10201
10202 case NOTE_INFO_MODULE:
10203 case NOTE_INFO_MODULE64:
10204 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
10205 if (type == NOTE_INFO_MODULE)
10206 {
10207 if (note->descsz < 12)
10208 return FALSE;
10209
10210 /* module_info.base_address */
10211 base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
10212 sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
10213 /* module_info.module_name_size */
10214 name_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
10215 }
10216 else /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE64 */
10217 {
10218 if (note->descsz < 16)
10219 return FALSE;
10220
10221 /* module_info.base_address */
10222 base_addr = bfd_get_64 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
10223 sprintf (buf, ".module/%016lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
10224 /* module_info.module_name_size */
10225 name_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
10226 }
10227
10228 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10229 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10230 if (name == NULL)
10231 return FALSE;
10232
10233 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10234
10235 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10236
10237 if (sect == NULL)
10238 return FALSE;
10239
10240 if (note->descsz < 12 + name_size)
10241 return FALSE;
10242
10243 sect->size = note->descsz;
10244 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10245 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10246 break;
10247
10248 default:
10249 return TRUE;
10250 }
10251
10252 return TRUE;
10253}
10254
10255static bfd_boolean
10256elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10257{
10258 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10259
10260 switch (note->type)
10261 {
10262 default:
10263 return TRUE;
10264
10265 case NT_PRSTATUS:
10266 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
10267 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
10268 return TRUE;
10269#if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
10270 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
10271#else
10272 return TRUE;
10273#endif
10274
10275#if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10276 case NT_PSTATUS:
10277 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
10278#endif
10279
10280#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10281 case NT_LWPSTATUS:
10282 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
10283#endif
10284
10285 case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
10286 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
10287
10288 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
10289 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
10290
10291 case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
10292 if (note->namesz == 6
10293 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10294 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
10295 else
10296 return TRUE;
10297
10298 case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
10299 if (note->namesz == 6
10300 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10301 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
10302 else
10303 return TRUE;
10304
10305 case NT_PPC_VMX:
10306 if (note->namesz == 6
10307 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10308 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
10309 else
10310 return TRUE;
10311
10312 case NT_PPC_VSX:
10313 if (note->namesz == 6
10314 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10315 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
10316 else
10317 return TRUE;
10318
10319 case NT_PPC_TAR:
10320 if (note->namesz == 6
10321 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10322 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (abfd, note);
10323 else
10324 return TRUE;
10325
10326 case NT_PPC_PPR:
10327 if (note->namesz == 6
10328 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10329 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (abfd, note);
10330 else
10331 return TRUE;
10332
10333 case NT_PPC_DSCR:
10334 if (note->namesz == 6
10335 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10336 return elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (abfd, note);
10337 else
10338 return TRUE;
10339
10340 case NT_PPC_EBB:
10341 if (note->namesz == 6
10342 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10343 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (abfd, note);
10344 else
10345 return TRUE;
10346
10347 case NT_PPC_PMU:
10348 if (note->namesz == 6
10349 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10350 return elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (abfd, note);
10351 else
10352 return TRUE;
10353
10354 case NT_PPC_TM_CGPR:
10355 if (note->namesz == 6
10356 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10357 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd, note);
10358 else
10359 return TRUE;
10360
10361 case NT_PPC_TM_CFPR:
10362 if (note->namesz == 6
10363 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10364 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd, note);
10365 else
10366 return TRUE;
10367
10368 case NT_PPC_TM_CVMX:
10369 if (note->namesz == 6
10370 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10371 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd, note);
10372 else
10373 return TRUE;
10374
10375 case NT_PPC_TM_CVSX:
10376 if (note->namesz == 6
10377 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10378 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd, note);
10379 else
10380 return TRUE;
10381
10382 case NT_PPC_TM_SPR:
10383 if (note->namesz == 6
10384 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10385 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (abfd, note);
10386 else
10387 return TRUE;
10388
10389 case NT_PPC_TM_CTAR:
10390 if (note->namesz == 6
10391 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10392 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd, note);
10393 else
10394 return TRUE;
10395
10396 case NT_PPC_TM_CPPR:
10397 if (note->namesz == 6
10398 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10399 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd, note);
10400 else
10401 return TRUE;
10402
10403 case NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR:
10404 if (note->namesz == 6
10405 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10406 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd, note);
10407 else
10408 return TRUE;
10409
10410 case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
10411 if (note->namesz == 6
10412 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10413 return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
10414 else
10415 return TRUE;
10416
10417 case NT_S390_TIMER:
10418 if (note->namesz == 6
10419 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10420 return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
10421 else
10422 return TRUE;
10423
10424 case NT_S390_TODCMP:
10425 if (note->namesz == 6
10426 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10427 return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
10428 else
10429 return TRUE;
10430
10431 case NT_S390_TODPREG:
10432 if (note->namesz == 6
10433 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10434 return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
10435 else
10436 return TRUE;
10437
10438 case NT_S390_CTRS:
10439 if (note->namesz == 6
10440 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10441 return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
10442 else
10443 return TRUE;
10444
10445 case NT_S390_PREFIX:
10446 if (note->namesz == 6
10447 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10448 return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
10449 else
10450 return TRUE;
10451
10452 case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
10453 if (note->namesz == 6
10454 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10455 return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
10456 else
10457 return TRUE;
10458
10459 case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
10460 if (note->namesz == 6
10461 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10462 return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
10463 else
10464 return TRUE;
10465
10466 case NT_S390_TDB:
10467 if (note->namesz == 6
10468 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10469 return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
10470 else
10471 return TRUE;
10472
10473 case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
10474 if (note->namesz == 6
10475 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10476 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
10477 else
10478 return TRUE;
10479
10480 case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
10481 if (note->namesz == 6
10482 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10483 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
10484 else
10485 return TRUE;
10486
10487 case NT_S390_GS_CB:
10488 if (note->namesz == 6
10489 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10490 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (abfd, note);
10491 else
10492 return TRUE;
10493
10494 case NT_S390_GS_BC:
10495 if (note->namesz == 6
10496 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10497 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (abfd, note);
10498 else
10499 return TRUE;
10500
10501 case NT_ARC_V2:
10502 if (note->namesz == 6
10503 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10504 return elfcore_grok_arc_v2 (abfd, note);
10505 else
10506 return TRUE;
10507
10508 case NT_ARM_VFP:
10509 if (note->namesz == 6
10510 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10511 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10512 else
10513 return TRUE;
10514
10515 case NT_ARM_TLS:
10516 if (note->namesz == 6
10517 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10518 return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
10519 else
10520 return TRUE;
10521
10522 case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
10523 if (note->namesz == 6
10524 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10525 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
10526 else
10527 return TRUE;
10528
10529 case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
10530 if (note->namesz == 6
10531 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10532 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
10533 else
10534 return TRUE;
10535
10536 case NT_ARM_SVE:
10537 if (note->namesz == 6
10538 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10539 return elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (abfd, note);
10540 else
10541 return TRUE;
10542
10543 case NT_ARM_PAC_MASK:
10544 if (note->namesz == 6
10545 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10546 return elfcore_grok_aarch_pauth (abfd, note);
10547 else
10548 return TRUE;
10549
10550 case NT_PRPSINFO:
10551 case NT_PSINFO:
10552 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
10553 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
10554 return TRUE;
10555#if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10556 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
10557#else
10558 return TRUE;
10559#endif
10560
10561 case NT_AUXV:
10562 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 0);
10563
10564 case NT_FILE:
10565 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
10566 note);
10567
10568 case NT_SIGINFO:
10569 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
10570 note);
10571
10572 }
10573}
10574
10575static bfd_boolean
10576elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10577{
10578 struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
10579
10580 if (note->descsz == 0)
10581 return FALSE;
10582
10583 build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
10584 if (build_id == NULL)
10585 return FALSE;
10586
10587 build_id->size = note->descsz;
10588 memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
10589 abfd->build_id = build_id;
10590
10591 return TRUE;
10592}
10593
10594static bfd_boolean
10595elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10596{
10597 switch (note->type)
10598 {
10599 default:
10600 return TRUE;
10601
10602 case NT_GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE_0:
10603 return _bfd_elf_parse_gnu_properties (abfd, note);
10604
10605 case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
10606 return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
10607 }
10608}
10609
10610static bfd_boolean
10611elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10612{
10613 struct sdt_note *cur =
10614 (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
10615 sizeof (struct sdt_note) + note->descsz);
10616
10617 cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
10618 cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
10619 memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
10620
10621 elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
10622
10623 return TRUE;
10624}
10625
10626static bfd_boolean
10627elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10628{
10629 switch (note->type)
10630 {
10631 case NT_STAPSDT:
10632 return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
10633
10634 default:
10635 return TRUE;
10636 }
10637}
10638
10639static bfd_boolean
10640elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10641{
10642 size_t offset;
10643
10644 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10645 {
10646 case ELFCLASS32:
10647 if (note->descsz < 108)
10648 return FALSE;
10649 break;
10650
10651 case ELFCLASS64:
10652 if (note->descsz < 120)
10653 return FALSE;
10654 break;
10655
10656 default:
10657 return FALSE;
10658 }
10659
10660 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10661 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10662 return FALSE;
10663
10664 offset = 4;
10665
10666 /* Skip over pr_psinfosz. */
10667 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10668 offset += 4;
10669 else
10670 {
10671 offset += 4; /* Padding before pr_psinfosz. */
10672 offset += 8;
10673 }
10674
10675 /* pr_fname is PRFNAMESZ (16) + 1 bytes in size. */
10676 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
10677 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 17);
10678 offset += 17;
10679
10680 /* pr_psargs is PRARGSZ (80) + 1 bytes in size. */
10681 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10682 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 81);
10683 offset += 81;
10684
10685 /* Padding before pr_pid. */
10686 offset += 2;
10687
10688 /* The pr_pid field was added in version "1a". */
10689 if (note->descsz < offset + 4)
10690 return TRUE;
10691
10692 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10693 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10694
10695 return TRUE;
10696}
10697
10698static bfd_boolean
10699elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10700{
10701 size_t offset;
10702 size_t size;
10703 size_t min_size;
10704
10705 /* Compute offset of pr_getregsz, skipping over pr_statussz.
10706 Also compute minimum size of this note. */
10707 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10708 {
10709 case ELFCLASS32:
10710 offset = 4 + 4;
10711 min_size = offset + (4 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4;
10712 break;
10713
10714 case ELFCLASS64:
10715 offset = 4 + 4 + 8; /* Includes padding before pr_statussz. */
10716 min_size = offset + (8 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4 + 4;
10717 break;
10718
10719 default:
10720 return FALSE;
10721 }
10722
10723 if (note->descsz < min_size)
10724 return FALSE;
10725
10726 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10727 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10728 return FALSE;
10729
10730 /* Extract size of pr_reg from pr_gregsetsz. */
10731 /* Skip over pr_gregsetsz and pr_fpregsetsz. */
10732 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10733 {
10734 size = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10735 offset += 4 * 2;
10736 }
10737 else
10738 {
10739 size = bfd_h_get_64 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10740 offset += 8 * 2;
10741 }
10742
10743 /* Skip over pr_osreldate. */
10744 offset += 4;
10745
10746 /* Read signal from pr_cursig. */
10747 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
10748 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10749 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10750 offset += 4;
10751
10752 /* Read TID from pr_pid. */
10753 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid
10754 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10755 offset += 4;
10756
10757 /* Padding before pr_reg. */
10758 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
10759 offset += 4;
10760
10761 /* Make sure that there is enough data remaining in the note. */
10762 if ((note->descsz - offset) < size)
10763 return FALSE;
10764
10765 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
10766 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
10767 size, note->descpos + offset);
10768}
10769
10770static bfd_boolean
10771elfcore_grok_freebsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10772{
10773 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10774
10775 switch (note->type)
10776 {
10777 case NT_PRSTATUS:
10778 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus)
10779 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus) (abfd, note))
10780 return TRUE;
10781 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (abfd, note);
10782
10783 case NT_FPREGSET:
10784 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
10785
10786 case NT_PRPSINFO:
10787 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (abfd, note);
10788
10789 case NT_FREEBSD_THRMISC:
10790 if (note->namesz == 8)
10791 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".thrmisc", note);
10792 else
10793 return TRUE;
10794
10795 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_PROC:
10796 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.proc",
10797 note);
10798
10799 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_FILES:
10800 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.files",
10801 note);
10802
10803 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_VMMAP:
10804 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.vmmap",
10805 note);
10806
10807 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_AUXV:
10808 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 4);
10809
10810 case NT_X86_XSTATE:
10811 if (note->namesz == 8)
10812 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
10813 else
10814 return TRUE;
10815
10816 case NT_FREEBSD_PTLWPINFO:
10817 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.lwpinfo",
10818 note);
10819
10820 case NT_ARM_VFP:
10821 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10822
10823 default:
10824 return TRUE;
10825 }
10826}
10827
10828static bfd_boolean
10829elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
10830{
10831 char *cp;
10832
10833 cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
10834 if (cp != NULL)
10835 {
10836 *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
10837 return TRUE;
10838 }
10839 return FALSE;
10840}
10841
10842static bfd_boolean
10843elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10844{
10845 if (note->descsz <= 0x7c + 31)
10846 return FALSE;
10847
10848 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10849 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10850 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10851
10852 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
10853 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10854 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
10855
10856 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10857 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10858 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
10859
10860 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
10861 note);
10862}
10863
10864static bfd_boolean
10865elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10866{
10867 int lwp;
10868
10869 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
10870 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
10871
10872 switch (note->type)
10873 {
10874 case NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO:
10875 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
10876 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
10877 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
10878 creates a core file. */
10879 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10880#ifdef NT_NETBSDCORE_AUXV
10881 case NT_NETBSDCORE_AUXV:
10882 /* NetBSD-specific Elf Auxiliary Vector data. */
10883 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 4);
10884#endif
10885#ifdef NT_NETBSDCORE_LWPSTATUS
10886 case NT_NETBSDCORE_LWPSTATUS:
10887 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd,
10888 ".note.netbsdcore.lwpstatus",
10889 note);
10890#endif
10891 default:
10892 break;
10893 }
10894
10895 /* As of March 2020 there are no other machine-independent notes
10896 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
10897 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
10898 understand it. */
10899
10900 if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
10901 return TRUE;
10902
10903
10904 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
10905 {
10906 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
10907 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
10908
10909 case bfd_arch_aarch64:
10910 case bfd_arch_alpha:
10911 case bfd_arch_sparc:
10912 switch (note->type)
10913 {
10914 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
10915 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10916
10917 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
10918 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10919
10920 default:
10921 return TRUE;
10922 }
10923
10924 /* On SuperH, PT_GETREGS == mach+3 and PT_GETFPREGS == mach+5.
10925 There's also old PT___GETREGS40 == mach + 1 for old reg
10926 structure which lacks GBR. */
10927
10928 case bfd_arch_sh:
10929 switch (note->type)
10930 {
10931 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
10932 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10933
10934 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+5:
10935 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10936
10937 default:
10938 return TRUE;
10939 }
10940
10941 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
10942 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
10943
10944 default:
10945 switch (note->type)
10946 {
10947 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
10948 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10949
10950 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
10951 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10952
10953 default:
10954 return TRUE;
10955 }
10956 }
10957 /* NOTREACHED */
10958}
10959
10960static bfd_boolean
10961elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10962{
10963 if (note->descsz <= 0x48 + 31)
10964 return FALSE;
10965
10966 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10967 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10968 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10969
10970 /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
10971 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10972 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
10973
10974 /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10975 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10976 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
10977
10978 return TRUE;
10979}
10980
10981static bfd_boolean
10982elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10983{
10984 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
10985 return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10986
10987 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
10988 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10989
10990 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
10991 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10992
10993 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
10994 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
10995
10996 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
10997 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 0);
10998
10999 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
11000 {
11001 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
11002 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
11003
11004 if (sect == NULL)
11005 return FALSE;
11006 sect->size = note->descsz;
11007 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
11008 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
11009
11010 return TRUE;
11011 }
11012
11013 return TRUE;
11014}
11015
11016static bfd_boolean
11017elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
11018{
11019 void *ddata = note->descdata;
11020 char buf[100];
11021 char *name;
11022 asection *sect;
11023 short sig;
11024 unsigned flags;
11025
11026 if (note->descsz < 16)
11027 return FALSE;
11028
11029 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
11030 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
11031
11032 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
11033 *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
11034
11035 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
11036 flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
11037
11038 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
11039 if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
11040 {
11041 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
11042 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
11043 }
11044
11045 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
11046 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
11047 thread just in case. */
11048 if (flags & 0x00000080)
11049 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
11050
11051 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
11052 sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
11053
11054 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
11055 if (name == NULL)
11056 return FALSE;
11057 strcpy (name, buf);
11058
11059 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
11060 if (sect == NULL)
11061 return FALSE;
11062
11063 sect->size = note->descsz;
11064 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
11065 sect->alignment_power = 2;
11066
11067 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
11068}
11069
11070static bfd_boolean
11071elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
11072 Elf_Internal_Note *note,
11073 long tid,
11074 char *base)
11075{
11076 char buf[100];
11077 char *name;
11078 asection *sect;
11079
11080 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
11081 sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
11082
11083 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
11084 if (name == NULL)
11085 return FALSE;
11086 strcpy (name, buf);
11087
11088 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
11089 if (sect == NULL)
11090 return FALSE;
11091
11092 sect->size = note->descsz;
11093 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
11094 sect->alignment_power = 2;
11095
11096 /* This is the current thread. */
11097 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
11098 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
11099
11100 return TRUE;
11101}
11102
11103#define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
11104#define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
11105#define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
11106#define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
11107
11108static bfd_boolean
11109elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
11110{
11111 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
11112 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
11113 function. */
11114 static long tid = 1;
11115
11116 switch (note->type)
11117 {
11118 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
11119 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
11120 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
11121 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
11122 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
11123 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
11124 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
11125 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
11126 default:
11127 return TRUE;
11128 }
11129}
11130
11131static bfd_boolean
11132elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
11133{
11134 char *name;
11135 asection *sect;
11136 size_t len;
11137
11138 /* Use note name as section name. */
11139 len = note->namesz;
11140 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
11141 if (name == NULL)
11142 return FALSE;
11143 memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
11144 name[len - 1] = '\0';
11145
11146 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
11147 if (sect == NULL)
11148 return FALSE;
11149
11150 sect->size = note->descsz;
11151 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
11152 sect->alignment_power = 1;
11153
11154 return TRUE;
11155}
11156
11157/* Function: elfcore_write_note
11158
11159 Inputs:
11160 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
11161 name of note
11162 type of note
11163 data for note
11164 size of data for note
11165
11166 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
11167 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
11168 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
11169 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
11170
11171 Return:
11172 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
11173
11174char *
11175elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
11176 char *buf,
11177 int *bufsiz,
11178 const char *name,
11179 int type,
11180 const void *input,
11181 int size)
11182{
11183 Elf_External_Note *xnp;
11184 size_t namesz;
11185 size_t newspace;
11186 char *dest;
11187
11188 namesz = 0;
11189 if (name != NULL)
11190 namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
11191
11192 newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
11193
11194 buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
11195 if (buf == NULL)
11196 return buf;
11197 dest = buf + *bufsiz;
11198 *bufsiz += newspace;
11199 xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
11200 H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
11201 H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
11202 H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
11203 dest = xnp->name;
11204 if (name != NULL)
11205 {
11206 memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
11207 dest += namesz;
11208 while (namesz & 3)
11209 {
11210 *dest++ = '\0';
11211 ++namesz;
11212 }
11213 }
11214 memcpy (dest, input, size);
11215 dest += size;
11216 while (size & 3)
11217 {
11218 *dest++ = '\0';
11219 ++size;
11220 }
11221 return buf;
11222}
11223
11224/* gcc-8 warns (*) on all the strncpy calls in this function about
11225 possible string truncation. The "truncation" is not a bug. We
11226 have an external representation of structs with fields that are not
11227 necessarily NULL terminated and corresponding internal
11228 representation fields that are one larger so that they can always
11229 be NULL terminated.
11230 gcc versions between 4.2 and 4.6 do not allow pragma control of
11231 diagnostics inside functions, giving a hard error if you try to use
11232 the finer control available with later versions.
11233 gcc prior to 4.2 warns about diagnostic push and pop.
11234 gcc-5, gcc-6 and gcc-7 warn that -Wstringop-truncation is unknown,
11235 unless you also add #pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragma".
11236 (*) Depending on your system header files! */
11237#if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
11238# pragma GCC diagnostic push
11239# pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wstringop-truncation"
11240#endif
11241char *
11242elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
11243 char *buf,
11244 int *bufsiz,
11245 const char *fname,
11246 const char *psargs)
11247{
11248 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11249
11250 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
11251 {
11252 char *ret;
11253 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11254 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
11255 if (ret != NULL)
11256 return ret;
11257 }
11258
11259#if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
11260# if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
11261 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
11262 {
11263# if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
11264 psinfo32_t data;
11265 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
11266# else
11267 prpsinfo32_t data;
11268 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
11269# endif
11270
11271 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
11272 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
11273 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
11274 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11275 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
11276 }
11277 else
11278# endif
11279 {
11280# if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
11281 psinfo_t data;
11282 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
11283# else
11284 prpsinfo_t data;
11285 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
11286# endif
11287
11288 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
11289 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
11290 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
11291 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11292 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
11293 }
11294#endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
11295
11296 free (buf);
11297 return NULL;
11298}
11299#if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
11300# pragma GCC diagnostic pop
11301#endif
11302
11303char *
11304elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
11305 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
11306 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
11307{
11308 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16)
11309 {
11310 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16 data;
11311
11312 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11313 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
11314 &data, sizeof (data));
11315 }
11316 else
11317 {
11318 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32 data;
11319
11320 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11321 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
11322 &data, sizeof (data));
11323 }
11324}
11325
11326char *
11327elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
11328 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
11329 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
11330{
11331 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16)
11332 {
11333 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16 data;
11334
11335 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11336 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11337 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
11338 }
11339 else
11340 {
11341 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32 data;
11342
11343 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11344 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11345 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
11346 }
11347}
11348
11349char *
11350elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
11351 char *buf,
11352 int *bufsiz,
11353 long pid,
11354 int cursig,
11355 const void *gregs)
11356{
11357 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11358
11359 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
11360 {
11361 char *ret;
11362 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11363 NT_PRSTATUS,
11364 pid, cursig, gregs);
11365 if (ret != NULL)
11366 return ret;
11367 }
11368
11369#if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
11370#if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
11371 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
11372 {
11373 prstatus32_t prstat;
11374
11375 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
11376 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
11377 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
11378 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
11379 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
11380 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
11381 }
11382 else
11383#endif
11384 {
11385 prstatus_t prstat;
11386
11387 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
11388 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
11389 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
11390 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
11391 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
11392 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
11393 }
11394#endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
11395
11396 free (buf);
11397 return NULL;
11398}
11399
11400#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
11401char *
11402elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
11403 char *buf,
11404 int *bufsiz,
11405 long pid,
11406 int cursig,
11407 const void *gregs)
11408{
11409 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
11410 const char *note_name = "CORE";
11411
11412 memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
11413 lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
11414 lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
11415#if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
11416 memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
11417#elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
11418#if !defined(gregs)
11419 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
11420 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
11421#else
11422 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
11423 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
11424#endif
11425#endif
11426 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
11427 NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
11428}
11429#endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
11430
11431#if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
11432char *
11433elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
11434 char *buf,
11435 int *bufsiz,
11436 long pid,
11437 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11438 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11439{
11440 const char *note_name = "CORE";
11441#if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
11442 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11443
11444 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
11445 {
11446 pstatus32_t pstat;
11447
11448 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
11449 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
11450 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
11451 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
11452 return buf;
11453 }
11454 else
11455#endif
11456 {
11457 pstatus_t pstat;
11458
11459 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
11460 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
11461 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
11462 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
11463 return buf;
11464 }
11465}
11466#endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
11467
11468char *
11469elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
11470 char *buf,
11471 int *bufsiz,
11472 const void *fpregs,
11473 int size)
11474{
11475 const char *note_name = "CORE";
11476 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11477 note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
11478}
11479
11480char *
11481elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
11482 char *buf,
11483 int *bufsiz,
11484 const void *xfpregs,
11485 int size)
11486{
11487 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11488 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11489 note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
11490}
11491
11492char *
11493elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
11494 const void *xfpregs, int size)
11495{
11496 char *note_name;
11497 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
11498 note_name = "FreeBSD";
11499 else
11500 note_name = "LINUX";
11501 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11502 note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
11503}
11504
11505char *
11506elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
11507 char *buf,
11508 int *bufsiz,
11509 const void *ppc_vmx,
11510 int size)
11511{
11512 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11513 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11514 note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
11515}
11516
11517char *
11518elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
11519 char *buf,
11520 int *bufsiz,
11521 const void *ppc_vsx,
11522 int size)
11523{
11524 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11525 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11526 note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
11527}
11528
11529char *
11530elfcore_write_ppc_tar (bfd *abfd,
11531 char *buf,
11532 int *bufsiz,
11533 const void *ppc_tar,
11534 int size)
11535{
11536 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11537 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11538 note_name, NT_PPC_TAR, ppc_tar, size);
11539}
11540
11541char *
11542elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (bfd *abfd,
11543 char *buf,
11544 int *bufsiz,
11545 const void *ppc_ppr,
11546 int size)
11547{
11548 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11549 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11550 note_name, NT_PPC_PPR, ppc_ppr, size);
11551}
11552
11553char *
11554elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (bfd *abfd,
11555 char *buf,
11556 int *bufsiz,
11557 const void *ppc_dscr,
11558 int size)
11559{
11560 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11561 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11562 note_name, NT_PPC_DSCR, ppc_dscr, size);
11563}
11564
11565char *
11566elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (bfd *abfd,
11567 char *buf,
11568 int *bufsiz,
11569 const void *ppc_ebb,
11570 int size)
11571{
11572 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11573 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11574 note_name, NT_PPC_EBB, ppc_ebb, size);
11575}
11576
11577char *
11578elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (bfd *abfd,
11579 char *buf,
11580 int *bufsiz,
11581 const void *ppc_pmu,
11582 int size)
11583{
11584 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11585 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11586 note_name, NT_PPC_PMU, ppc_pmu, size);
11587}
11588
11589char *
11590elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd *abfd,
11591 char *buf,
11592 int *bufsiz,
11593 const void *ppc_tm_cgpr,
11594 int size)
11595{
11596 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11597 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11598 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CGPR, ppc_tm_cgpr, size);
11599}
11600
11601char *
11602elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd *abfd,
11603 char *buf,
11604 int *bufsiz,
11605 const void *ppc_tm_cfpr,
11606 int size)
11607{
11608 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11609 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11610 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CFPR, ppc_tm_cfpr, size);
11611}
11612
11613char *
11614elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd *abfd,
11615 char *buf,
11616 int *bufsiz,
11617 const void *ppc_tm_cvmx,
11618 int size)
11619{
11620 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11621 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11622 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CVMX, ppc_tm_cvmx, size);
11623}
11624
11625char *
11626elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd *abfd,
11627 char *buf,
11628 int *bufsiz,
11629 const void *ppc_tm_cvsx,
11630 int size)
11631{
11632 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11633 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11634 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CVSX, ppc_tm_cvsx, size);
11635}
11636
11637char *
11638elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (bfd *abfd,
11639 char *buf,
11640 int *bufsiz,
11641 const void *ppc_tm_spr,
11642 int size)
11643{
11644 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11645 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11646 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_SPR, ppc_tm_spr, size);
11647}
11648
11649char *
11650elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd *abfd,
11651 char *buf,
11652 int *bufsiz,
11653 const void *ppc_tm_ctar,
11654 int size)
11655{
11656 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11657 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11658 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CTAR, ppc_tm_ctar, size);
11659}
11660
11661char *
11662elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd *abfd,
11663 char *buf,
11664 int *bufsiz,
11665 const void *ppc_tm_cppr,
11666 int size)
11667{
11668 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11669 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11670 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CPPR, ppc_tm_cppr, size);
11671}
11672
11673char *
11674elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd *abfd,
11675 char *buf,
11676 int *bufsiz,
11677 const void *ppc_tm_cdscr,
11678 int size)
11679{
11680 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11681 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11682 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR, ppc_tm_cdscr, size);
11683}
11684
11685static char *
11686elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
11687 char *buf,
11688 int *bufsiz,
11689 const void *s390_high_gprs,
11690 int size)
11691{
11692 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11693 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11694 note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
11695 s390_high_gprs, size);
11696}
11697
11698char *
11699elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
11700 char *buf,
11701 int *bufsiz,
11702 const void *s390_timer,
11703 int size)
11704{
11705 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11706 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11707 note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
11708}
11709
11710char *
11711elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
11712 char *buf,
11713 int *bufsiz,
11714 const void *s390_todcmp,
11715 int size)
11716{
11717 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11718 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11719 note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
11720}
11721
11722char *
11723elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
11724 char *buf,
11725 int *bufsiz,
11726 const void *s390_todpreg,
11727 int size)
11728{
11729 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11730 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11731 note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
11732}
11733
11734char *
11735elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
11736 char *buf,
11737 int *bufsiz,
11738 const void *s390_ctrs,
11739 int size)
11740{
11741 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11742 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11743 note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
11744}
11745
11746char *
11747elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
11748 char *buf,
11749 int *bufsiz,
11750 const void *s390_prefix,
11751 int size)
11752{
11753 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11754 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11755 note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
11756}
11757
11758char *
11759elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
11760 char *buf,
11761 int *bufsiz,
11762 const void *s390_last_break,
11763 int size)
11764{
11765 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11766 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11767 note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
11768 s390_last_break, size);
11769}
11770
11771char *
11772elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
11773 char *buf,
11774 int *bufsiz,
11775 const void *s390_system_call,
11776 int size)
11777{
11778 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11779 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11780 note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
11781 s390_system_call, size);
11782}
11783
11784char *
11785elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
11786 char *buf,
11787 int *bufsiz,
11788 const void *s390_tdb,
11789 int size)
11790{
11791 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11792 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11793 note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
11794}
11795
11796char *
11797elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
11798 char *buf,
11799 int *bufsiz,
11800 const void *s390_vxrs_low,
11801 int size)
11802{
11803 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11804 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11805 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
11806}
11807
11808char *
11809elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
11810 char *buf,
11811 int *bufsiz,
11812 const void *s390_vxrs_high,
11813 int size)
11814{
11815 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11816 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11817 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
11818 s390_vxrs_high, size);
11819}
11820
11821char *
11822elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd,
11823 char *buf,
11824 int *bufsiz,
11825 const void *s390_gs_cb,
11826 int size)
11827{
11828 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11829 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11830 note_name, NT_S390_GS_CB,
11831 s390_gs_cb, size);
11832}
11833
11834char *
11835elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd,
11836 char *buf,
11837 int *bufsiz,
11838 const void *s390_gs_bc,
11839 int size)
11840{
11841 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11842 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11843 note_name, NT_S390_GS_BC,
11844 s390_gs_bc, size);
11845}
11846
11847char *
11848elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
11849 char *buf,
11850 int *bufsiz,
11851 const void *arm_vfp,
11852 int size)
11853{
11854 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11855 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11856 note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
11857}
11858
11859char *
11860elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
11861 char *buf,
11862 int *bufsiz,
11863 const void *aarch_tls,
11864 int size)
11865{
11866 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11867 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11868 note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
11869}
11870
11871char *
11872elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
11873 char *buf,
11874 int *bufsiz,
11875 const void *aarch_hw_break,
11876 int size)
11877{
11878 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11879 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11880 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
11881}
11882
11883char *
11884elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
11885 char *buf,
11886 int *bufsiz,
11887 const void *aarch_hw_watch,
11888 int size)
11889{
11890 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11891 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11892 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
11893}
11894
11895char *
11896elfcore_write_aarch_sve (bfd *abfd,
11897 char *buf,
11898 int *bufsiz,
11899 const void *aarch_sve,
11900 int size)
11901{
11902 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11903 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11904 note_name, NT_ARM_SVE, aarch_sve, size);
11905}
11906
11907char *
11908elfcore_write_aarch_pauth (bfd *abfd,
11909 char *buf,
11910 int *bufsiz,
11911 const void *aarch_pauth,
11912 int size)
11913{
11914 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11915 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11916 note_name, NT_ARM_PAC_MASK, aarch_pauth, size);
11917}
11918
11919char *
11920elfcore_write_arc_v2 (bfd *abfd,
11921 char *buf,
11922 int *bufsiz,
11923 const void *arc_v2,
11924 int size)
11925{
11926 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11927 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11928 note_name, NT_ARC_V2, arc_v2, size);
11929}
11930
11931char *
11932elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
11933 char *buf,
11934 int *bufsiz,
11935 const char *section,
11936 const void *data,
11937 int size)
11938{
11939 if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
11940 return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11941 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
11942 return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11943 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
11944 return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11945 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
11946 return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11947 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
11948 return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11949 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tar") == 0)
11950 return elfcore_write_ppc_tar (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11951 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-ppr") == 0)
11952 return elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11953 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-dscr") == 0)
11954 return elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11955 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-ebb") == 0)
11956 return elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11957 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-pmu") == 0)
11958 return elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11959 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr") == 0)
11960 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11961 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr") == 0)
11962 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11963 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx") == 0)
11964 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11965 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx") == 0)
11966 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11967 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr") == 0)
11968 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11969 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar") == 0)
11970 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11971 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr") == 0)
11972 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11973 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr") == 0)
11974 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11975 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
11976 return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11977 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
11978 return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11979 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
11980 return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11981 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
11982 return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11983 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
11984 return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11985 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
11986 return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11987 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
11988 return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11989 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
11990 return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11991 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
11992 return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11993 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
11994 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11995 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
11996 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11997 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-cb") == 0)
11998 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11999 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-bc") == 0)
12000 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12001 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
12002 return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12003 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
12004 return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12005 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
12006 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12007 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
12008 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12009 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-sve") == 0)
12010 return elfcore_write_aarch_sve (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12011 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-pauth") == 0)
12012 return elfcore_write_aarch_pauth (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12013 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arc-v2") == 0)
12014 return elfcore_write_arc_v2 (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12015 return NULL;
12016}
12017
12018static bfd_boolean
12019elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset,
12020 size_t align)
12021{
12022 char *p;
12023
12024 /* NB: CORE PT_NOTE segments may have p_align values of 0 or 1.
12025 gABI specifies that PT_NOTE alignment should be aligned to 4
12026 bytes for 32-bit objects and to 8 bytes for 64-bit objects. If
12027 align is less than 4, we use 4 byte alignment. */
12028 if (align < 4)
12029 align = 4;
12030 if (align != 4 && align != 8)
12031 return FALSE;
12032
12033 p = buf;
12034 while (p < buf + size)
12035 {
12036 Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
12037 Elf_Internal_Note in;
12038
12039 if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
12040 return FALSE;
12041
12042 in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
12043
12044 in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
12045 in.namedata = xnp->name;
12046 if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
12047 return FALSE;
12048
12049 in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
12050 in.descdata = p + ELF_NOTE_DESC_OFFSET (in.namesz, align);
12051 in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
12052 if (in.descsz != 0
12053 && (in.descdata >= buf + size
12054 || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
12055 return FALSE;
12056
12057 switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
12058 {
12059 default:
12060 return TRUE;
12061
12062 case bfd_core:
12063 {
12064#define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
12065 struct
12066 {
12067 const char * string;
12068 size_t len;
12069 bfd_boolean (* func)(bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
12070 }
12071 grokers[] =
12072 {
12073 GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
12074 GROKER_ELEMENT ("FreeBSD", elfcore_grok_freebsd_note),
12075 GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
12076 GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
12077 GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
12078 GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note),
12079 GROKER_ELEMENT ("GNU", elfobj_grok_gnu_note)
12080 };
12081#undef GROKER_ELEMENT
12082 int i;
12083
12084 for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
12085 {
12086 if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
12087 && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
12088 grokers[i].len) == 0)
12089 {
12090 if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
12091 return FALSE;
12092 break;
12093 }
12094 }
12095 break;
12096 }
12097
12098 case bfd_object:
12099 if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
12100 {
12101 if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
12102 return FALSE;
12103 }
12104 else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
12105 && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
12106 {
12107 if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
12108 return FALSE;
12109 }
12110 break;
12111 }
12112
12113 p += ELF_NOTE_NEXT_OFFSET (in.namesz, in.descsz, align);
12114 }
12115
12116 return TRUE;
12117}
12118
12119bfd_boolean
12120elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size,
12121 size_t align)
12122{
12123 char *buf;
12124
12125 if (size == 0 || (size + 1) == 0)
12126 return TRUE;
12127
12128 if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
12129 return FALSE;
12130
12131 buf = (char *) _bfd_malloc_and_read (abfd, size + 1, size);
12132 if (buf == NULL)
12133 return FALSE;
12134
12135 /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
12136 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
12137 buf[size] = 0;
12138
12139 if (!elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset, align))
12140 {
12141 free (buf);
12142 return FALSE;
12143 }
12144
12145 free (buf);
12146 return TRUE;
12147}
12148\f
12149/* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
12150
12151/* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
12152 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
12153 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
12154
12155long
12156bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
12157{
12158 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
12159 {
12160 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
12161 return -1;
12162 }
12163
12164 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
12165}
12166
12167/* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
12168 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
12169 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
12170 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
12171
12172 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
12173 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
12174
12175int
12176bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
12177{
12178 int num_phdrs;
12179
12180 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
12181 {
12182 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
12183 return -1;
12184 }
12185
12186 num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
12187 if (num_phdrs != 0)
12188 memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
12189 num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
12190
12191 return num_phdrs;
12192}
12193
12194enum elf_reloc_type_class
12195_bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12196 const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12197 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12198{
12199 return reloc_class_normal;
12200}
12201
12202/* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
12203 relocation against a local symbol. */
12204
12205bfd_vma
12206_bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
12207 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
12208 asection **psec,
12209 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
12210{
12211 asection *sec = *psec;
12212 bfd_vma relocation;
12213
12214 relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
12215 + sec->output_offset
12216 + sym->st_value);
12217 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
12218 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
12219 && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
12220 {
12221 rel->r_addend =
12222 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
12223 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
12224 sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
12225 if (sec != *psec)
12226 {
12227 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
12228 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
12229 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
12230 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
12231 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
12232 if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
12233 sec->kept_section = *psec;
12234 sec = *psec;
12235 }
12236 rel->r_addend -= relocation;
12237 rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
12238 }
12239 return relocation;
12240}
12241
12242bfd_vma
12243_bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
12244 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
12245 asection **psec,
12246 bfd_vma addend)
12247{
12248 asection *sec = *psec;
12249
12250 if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
12251 return sym->st_value + addend;
12252
12253 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
12254 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
12255 sym->st_value + addend);
12256}
12257
12258/* Adjust an address within a section. Given OFFSET within SEC, return
12259 the new offset within the section, based upon changes made to the
12260 section. Returns -1 if the offset is now invalid.
12261 The offset (in abnd out) is in target sized bytes, however big a
12262 byte may be. */
12263
12264bfd_vma
12265_bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
12266 struct bfd_link_info *info,
12267 asection *sec,
12268 bfd_vma offset)
12269{
12270 switch (sec->sec_info_type)
12271 {
12272 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
12273 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
12274 offset);
12275 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
12276 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
12277
12278 default:
12279 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
12280 {
12281 /* Reverse the offset. */
12282 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12283 bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
12284
12285 /* address_size and sec->size are in octets. Convert
12286 to bytes before subtracting the original offset. */
12287 offset = ((sec->size - address_size)
12288 / bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) - offset);
12289 }
12290 return offset;
12291 }
12292}
12293\f
12294/* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
12295 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
12296 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
12297 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
12298 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
12299 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
12300
12301 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
12302 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
12303 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
12304 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
12305 the remote memory. */
12306
12307bfd *
12308bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
12309 (bfd *templ,
12310 bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
12311 bfd_size_type size,
12312 bfd_vma *loadbasep,
12313 int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
12314{
12315 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
12316 (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
12317}
12318\f
12319long
12320_bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
12321 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12322 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12323 long dynsymcount,
12324 asymbol **dynsyms,
12325 asymbol **ret)
12326{
12327 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12328 asection *relplt;
12329 asymbol *s;
12330 const char *relplt_name;
12331 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
12332 arelent *p;
12333 long count, i, n;
12334 size_t size;
12335 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
12336 char *names;
12337 asection *plt;
12338
12339 *ret = NULL;
12340
12341 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
12342 return 0;
12343
12344 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
12345 return 0;
12346
12347 if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
12348 return 0;
12349
12350 relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
12351 if (relplt_name == NULL)
12352 relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
12353 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
12354 if (relplt == NULL)
12355 return 0;
12356
12357 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
12358 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
12359 || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
12360 return 0;
12361
12362 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
12363 if (plt == NULL)
12364 return 0;
12365
12366 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
12367 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
12368 return -1;
12369
12370 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
12371 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
12372 p = relplt->relocation;
12373 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
12374 {
12375 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
12376 if (p->addend != 0)
12377 {
12378#ifdef BFD64
12379 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
12380#else
12381 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
12382#endif
12383 }
12384 }
12385
12386 s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
12387 if (s == NULL)
12388 return -1;
12389
12390 names = (char *) (s + count);
12391 p = relplt->relocation;
12392 n = 0;
12393 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
12394 {
12395 size_t len;
12396 bfd_vma addr;
12397
12398 addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
12399 if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
12400 continue;
12401
12402 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
12403 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
12404 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
12405 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
12406 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
12407 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
12408 s->section = plt;
12409 s->value = addr - plt->vma;
12410 s->name = names;
12411 s->udata.p = NULL;
12412 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
12413 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
12414 names += len;
12415 if (p->addend != 0)
12416 {
12417 char buf[30], *a;
12418
12419 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
12420 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
12421 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
12422 for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
12423 ;
12424 len = strlen (a);
12425 memcpy (names, a, len);
12426 names += len;
12427 }
12428 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
12429 names += sizeof ("@plt");
12430 ++s, ++n;
12431 }
12432
12433 return n;
12434}
12435
12436/* It is only used by x86-64 so far.
12437 ??? This repeats *COM* id of zero. sec->id is supposed to be unique,
12438 but current usage would allow all of _bfd_std_section to be zero. */
12439static const asymbol lcomm_sym
12440 = GLOBAL_SYM_INIT ("LARGE_COMMON", &_bfd_elf_large_com_section);
12441asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
12442 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section, &lcomm_sym,
12443 "LARGE_COMMON", 0, SEC_IS_COMMON);
12444
12445bfd_boolean
12446_bfd_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
12447{
12448 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
12449
12450 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
12451
12452 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE)
12453 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
12454
12455 /* Set the osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains
12456 SHF_GNU_MBIND sections or symbols of STT_GNU_IFUNC type or
12457 STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
12458 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi != 0)
12459 {
12460 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE)
12461 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
12462 else if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] != ELFOSABI_GNU
12463 && i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] != ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
12464 {
12465 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind)
12466 _bfd_error_handler (_("GNU_MBIND section is unsupported"));
12467 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_ifunc)
12468 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol type STT_GNU_IFUNC is unsupported"));
12469 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_unique)
12470 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol binding STB_GNU_UNIQUE is unsupported"));
12471 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry);
12472 return FALSE;
12473 }
12474 }
12475 return TRUE;
12476}
12477
12478
12479/* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
12480 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
12481 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
12482
12483bfd_boolean
12484_bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
12485{
12486 return (type == STT_FUNC
12487 || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
12488}
12489
12490/* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
12491 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
12492 otherwise return zero. */
12493
12494bfd_size_type
12495_bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
12496 bfd_vma *code_off)
12497{
12498 bfd_size_type size;
12499
12500 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
12501 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
12502 || sym->section != sec)
12503 return 0;
12504
12505 *code_off = sym->value;
12506 size = 0;
12507 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
12508 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
12509 if (size == 0)
12510 size = 1;
12511 return size;
12512}
12513
12514/* Set to non-zero to enable some debug messages. */
12515#define DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS 0
12516
12517/* An internal-to-the-bfd-library only section type
12518 used to indicate a cached secondary reloc section. */
12519#define SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC (SHT_LOOS + SHT_RELA)
12520
12521/* Create a BFD section to hold a secondary reloc section. */
12522
12523bfd_boolean
12524_bfd_elf_init_secondary_reloc_section (bfd * abfd,
12525 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
12526 const char * name,
12527 unsigned int shindex)
12528{
12529 /* We only support RELA secondary relocs. */
12530 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA)
12531 return FALSE;
12532
12533#if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12534 fprintf (stderr, "secondary reloc section %s encountered\n", name);
12535#endif
12536 hdr->sh_type = SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC;
12537 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
12538}
12539
12540/* Read in any secondary relocs associated with SEC. */
12541
12542bfd_boolean
12543_bfd_elf_slurp_secondary_reloc_section (bfd * abfd,
12544 asection * sec,
12545 asymbol ** symbols)
12546{
12547 const struct elf_backend_data * const ebd = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12548 asection * relsec;
12549 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
12550 bfd_vma (*r_sym) (bfd_vma);
12551
12552#if BFD_DEFAULT_TARGET_SIZE > 32
12553 if (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) != 32)
12554 r_sym = elf64_r_sym;
12555 else
12556#endif
12557 r_sym = elf32_r_sym;
12558
12559 /* Discover if there are any secondary reloc sections
12560 associated with SEC. */
12561 for (relsec = abfd->sections; relsec != NULL; relsec = relsec->next)
12562 {
12563 Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr = & elf_section_data (relsec)->this_hdr;
12564
12565 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC
12566 && hdr->sh_info == (unsigned) elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx)
12567 {
12568 bfd_byte * native_relocs;
12569 bfd_byte * native_reloc;
12570 arelent * internal_relocs;
12571 arelent * internal_reloc;
12572 unsigned int i;
12573 unsigned int entsize;
12574 unsigned int symcount;
12575 unsigned int reloc_count;
12576 size_t amt;
12577
12578 if (ebd->elf_info_to_howto == NULL)
12579 return FALSE;
12580
12581#if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12582 fprintf (stderr, "read secondary relocs for %s from %s\n",
12583 sec->name, relsec->name);
12584#endif
12585 entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
12586
12587 native_relocs = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
12588 if (native_relocs == NULL)
12589 {
12590 result = FALSE;
12591 continue;
12592 }
12593
12594 reloc_count = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr);
12595 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (reloc_count, sizeof (arelent), & amt))
12596 {
12597 free (native_relocs);
12598 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
12599 result = FALSE;
12600 continue;
12601 }
12602
12603 internal_relocs = (arelent *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
12604 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
12605 {
12606 free (native_relocs);
12607 result = FALSE;
12608 continue;
12609 }
12610
12611 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
12612 || (bfd_bread (native_relocs, hdr->sh_size, abfd)
12613 != hdr->sh_size))
12614 {
12615 free (native_relocs);
12616 /* The internal_relocs will be freed when
12617 the memory for the bfd is released. */
12618 result = FALSE;
12619 continue;
12620 }
12621
12622 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
12623
12624 for (i = 0, internal_reloc = internal_relocs,
12625 native_reloc = native_relocs;
12626 i < reloc_count;
12627 i++, internal_reloc++, native_reloc += entsize)
12628 {
12629 bfd_boolean res;
12630 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
12631
12632 ebd->s->swap_reloca_in (abfd, native_reloc, & rela);
12633
12634 /* The address of an ELF reloc is section relative for an object
12635 file, and absolute for an executable file or shared library.
12636 The address of a normal BFD reloc is always section relative,
12637 and the address of a dynamic reloc is absolute.. */
12638 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0)
12639 internal_reloc->address = rela.r_offset;
12640 else
12641 internal_reloc->address = rela.r_offset - sec->vma;
12642
12643 if (r_sym (rela.r_info) == STN_UNDEF)
12644 {
12645 /* FIXME: This and the error case below mean that we
12646 have a symbol on relocs that is not elf_symbol_type. */
12647 internal_reloc->sym_ptr_ptr =
12648 bfd_abs_section_ptr->symbol_ptr_ptr;
12649 }
12650 else if (r_sym (rela.r_info) > symcount)
12651 {
12652 _bfd_error_handler
12653 /* xgettext:c-format */
12654 (_("%pB(%pA): relocation %d has invalid symbol index %ld"),
12655 abfd, sec, i, (long) r_sym (rela.r_info));
12656 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12657 internal_reloc->sym_ptr_ptr =
12658 bfd_abs_section_ptr->symbol_ptr_ptr;
12659 result = FALSE;
12660 }
12661 else
12662 {
12663 asymbol **ps;
12664
12665 ps = symbols + r_sym (rela.r_info) - 1;
12666
12667 internal_reloc->sym_ptr_ptr = ps;
12668 /* Make sure that this symbol is not removed by strip. */
12669 (*ps)->flags |= BSF_KEEP;
12670 }
12671
12672 internal_reloc->addend = rela.r_addend;
12673
12674 res = ebd->elf_info_to_howto (abfd, internal_reloc, & rela);
12675 if (! res || internal_reloc->howto == NULL)
12676 {
12677#if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12678 fprintf (stderr, "there is no howto associated with reloc %lx\n",
12679 rela.r_info);
12680#endif
12681 result = FALSE;
12682 }
12683 }
12684
12685 free (native_relocs);
12686 /* Store the internal relocs. */
12687 elf_section_data (relsec)->sec_info = internal_relocs;
12688 }
12689 }
12690
12691 return result;
12692}
12693
12694/* Set the ELF section header fields of an output secondary reloc section. */
12695
12696bfd_boolean
12697_bfd_elf_copy_special_section_fields (const bfd * ibfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12698 bfd * obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12699 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * isection,
12700 Elf_Internal_Shdr * osection)
12701{
12702 asection * isec;
12703 asection * osec;
12704
12705 if (isection == NULL)
12706 return FALSE;
12707
12708 if (isection->sh_type != SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC)
12709 return TRUE;
12710
12711 isec = isection->bfd_section;
12712 if (isec == NULL)
12713 return FALSE;
12714
12715 osec = osection->bfd_section;
12716 if (osec == NULL)
12717 return FALSE;
12718
12719 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec)->sec_info == NULL);
12720 elf_section_data (osec)->sec_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
12721 osection->sh_type = SHT_RELA;
12722 osection->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (obfd);
12723 if (osection->sh_link == 0)
12724 {
12725 /* There is no symbol table - we are hosed... */
12726 _bfd_error_handler
12727 /* xgettext:c-format */
12728 (_("%pB(%pA): link section cannot be set because the output file does not have a symbol table"),
12729 obfd, osec);
12730 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12731 return FALSE;
12732 }
12733
12734 /* Find the output section that corresponds to the isection's sh_info link. */
12735 if (isection->sh_info == 0
12736 || isection->sh_info >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
12737 {
12738 _bfd_error_handler
12739 /* xgettext:c-format */
12740 (_("%pB(%pA): info section index is invalid"),
12741 obfd, osec);
12742 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12743 return FALSE;
12744 }
12745
12746 isection = elf_elfsections (ibfd)[isection->sh_info];
12747
12748 if (isection == NULL
12749 || isection->bfd_section == NULL
12750 || isection->bfd_section->output_section == NULL)
12751 {
12752 _bfd_error_handler
12753 /* xgettext:c-format */
12754 (_("%pB(%pA): info section index cannot be set because the section is not in the output"),
12755 obfd, osec);
12756 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12757 return FALSE;
12758 }
12759
12760 osection->sh_info =
12761 elf_section_data (isection->bfd_section->output_section)->this_idx;
12762
12763#if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12764 fprintf (stderr, "update header of %s, sh_link = %u, sh_info = %u\n",
12765 osec->name, osection->sh_link, osection->sh_info);
12766#endif
12767
12768 return TRUE;
12769}
12770
12771/* Write out a secondary reloc section. */
12772
12773bfd_boolean
12774_bfd_elf_write_secondary_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
12775{
12776 const struct elf_backend_data * const ebd = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12777 bfd_vma addr_offset;
12778 asection * relsec;
12779 bfd_vma (*r_info) (bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
12780 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
12781
12782 if (sec == NULL)
12783 return FALSE;
12784
12785#if BFD_DEFAULT_TARGET_SIZE > 32
12786 if (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) != 32)
12787 r_info = elf64_r_info;
12788 else
12789#endif
12790 r_info = elf32_r_info;
12791
12792 /* The address of an ELF reloc is section relative for an object
12793 file, and absolute for an executable file or shared library.
12794 The address of a BFD reloc is always section relative. */
12795 addr_offset = 0;
12796 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) != 0)
12797 addr_offset = sec->vma;
12798
12799 /* Discover if there are any secondary reloc sections
12800 associated with SEC. */
12801 for (relsec = abfd->sections; relsec != NULL; relsec = relsec->next)
12802 {
12803 const struct bfd_elf_section_data * const esd = elf_section_data (relsec);
12804 Elf_Internal_Shdr * const hdr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) & esd->this_hdr;
12805
12806 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA
12807 && hdr->sh_info == (unsigned) elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx)
12808 {
12809 asymbol * last_sym;
12810 int last_sym_idx;
12811 unsigned int reloc_count;
12812 unsigned int idx;
12813 arelent * src_irel;
12814 bfd_byte * dst_rela;
12815
12816 if (hdr->contents != NULL)
12817 {
12818 _bfd_error_handler
12819 /* xgettext:c-format */
12820 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section processed twice"),
12821 abfd, relsec);
12822 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12823 result = FALSE;
12824 continue;
12825 }
12826
12827 reloc_count = hdr->sh_size / hdr->sh_entsize;
12828 if (reloc_count <= 0)
12829 {
12830 _bfd_error_handler
12831 /* xgettext:c-format */
12832 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section is empty!"),
12833 abfd, relsec);
12834 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12835 result = FALSE;
12836 continue;
12837 }
12838
12839 hdr->contents = bfd_alloc (abfd, hdr->sh_size);
12840 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
12841 continue;
12842
12843#if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12844 fprintf (stderr, "write %u secondary relocs for %s from %s\n",
12845 reloc_count, sec->name, relsec->name);
12846#endif
12847 last_sym = NULL;
12848 last_sym_idx = 0;
12849 dst_rela = hdr->contents;
12850 src_irel = (arelent *) esd->sec_info;
12851 if (src_irel == NULL)
12852 {
12853 _bfd_error_handler
12854 /* xgettext:c-format */
12855 (_("%pB(%pA): error: internal relocs missing for secondary reloc section"),
12856 abfd, relsec);
12857 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12858 result = FALSE;
12859 continue;
12860 }
12861
12862 for (idx = 0; idx < reloc_count; idx++, dst_rela += hdr->sh_entsize)
12863 {
12864 Elf_Internal_Rela src_rela;
12865 arelent *ptr;
12866 asymbol *sym;
12867 int n;
12868
12869 ptr = src_irel + idx;
12870 if (ptr == NULL)
12871 {
12872 _bfd_error_handler
12873 /* xgettext:c-format */
12874 (_("%pB(%pA): error: reloc table entry %u is empty"),
12875 abfd, relsec, idx);
12876 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12877 result = FALSE;
12878 break;
12879 }
12880
12881 if (ptr->sym_ptr_ptr == NULL)
12882 {
12883 /* FIXME: Is this an error ? */
12884 n = 0;
12885 }
12886 else
12887 {
12888 sym = *ptr->sym_ptr_ptr;
12889
12890 if (sym == last_sym)
12891 n = last_sym_idx;
12892 else
12893 {
12894 n = _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (abfd, & sym);
12895 if (n < 0)
12896 {
12897 _bfd_error_handler
12898 /* xgettext:c-format */
12899 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc %u references a missing symbol"),
12900 abfd, relsec, idx);
12901 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12902 result = FALSE;
12903 n = 0;
12904 }
12905
12906 last_sym = sym;
12907 last_sym_idx = n;
12908 }
12909
12910 if (sym->the_bfd != NULL
12911 && sym->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec
12912 && ! _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (abfd, ptr))
12913 {
12914 _bfd_error_handler
12915 /* xgettext:c-format */
12916 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc %u references a deleted symbol"),
12917 abfd, relsec, idx);
12918 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12919 result = FALSE;
12920 n = 0;
12921 }
12922 }
12923
12924 src_rela.r_offset = ptr->address + addr_offset;
12925 if (ptr->howto == NULL)
12926 {
12927 _bfd_error_handler
12928 /* xgettext:c-format */
12929 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc %u is of an unknown type"),
12930 abfd, relsec, idx);
12931 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12932 result = FALSE;
12933 src_rela.r_info = r_info (0, 0);
12934 }
12935 else
12936 src_rela.r_info = r_info (n, ptr->howto->type);
12937 src_rela.r_addend = ptr->addend;
12938 ebd->s->swap_reloca_out (abfd, &src_rela, dst_rela);
12939 }
12940 }
12941 }
12942
12943 return result;
12944}